Compactlogix 5370 Controllers: User Manual

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 272

CompactLogix 5370 Controllers

1769-L16ER-BB1B, 1769-L18ER-BB1B, 1769-L18ERM-BB1B,


1769-L18ERM-BB1BK, 1769-L19ER-BB1B, 1769-L19ER-BB1BK,
1769-L24ER-QB1B, 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B, 1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK,
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B, 1769-L30ER, 1769-L30ER-NSE,
1769-L30ERK, 1769-L30ERM, 1769-L30ERMK, 1769-L33ERMO,
1769-L33ER, 1769-L33ERK, 1769-L33ERM, 1769-L33ERMK,
1769-L36ERM, 1769-L36ERMO, 1769-L37ERM, 1769-L37ERMK,
1769-L37ERMO, 1769-L38ERM, 1769-L38ERMK, 1769-L38ERMO

User Manual Original Instructions


CompactLogix 5370 Controllers User Manual

Important User Information


Read this document and the documents listed in the additional resources section about installation, configuration, and operation of this equipment before
you install, configure, operate, or maintain this product. Users are required to familiarize themselves with installation and wiring instructions in addition to
requirements of all applicable codes, laws, and standards.

Activities including installation, adjustments, putting into service, use, assembly, disassembly, and maintenance are required to be carried out by suitably
trained personnel in accordance with applicable code of practice.

If this equipment is used in a manner not specified by the manufacturer, the protection provided by the equipment may be impaired.

In no event will Rockwell Automation, Inc. be responsible or liable for indirect or consequential damages resulting from the use or application of
this equipment.

The examples and diagrams in this manual are included solely for illustrative purposes. Because of the many variables and requirements associated with
any particular installation, Rockwell Automation, Inc. cannot assume responsibility or liability for actual use based on the examples and diagrams.

No patent liability is assumed by Rockwell Automation, Inc. with respect to use of information, circuits, equipment, or software described in this manual.

Reproduction of the contents of this manual, in whole or in part, without written permission of Rockwell Automation, Inc., is prohibited.

Throughout this manual, when necessary, we use notes to make you aware of safety considerations.

WARNING: Identifies information about practices or circumstances that can cause an explosion in a hazardous environment,
which may lead to personal injury or death, property damage, or economic loss.

ATTENTION: Identifies information about practices or circumstances that can lead to personal injury or death, property
damage, or economic loss. Attentions help you identify a hazard, avoid a hazard, and recognize the consequence.

IMPORTANT Identifies information that is critical for successful application and understanding of the product.

These labels may also be on or inside the equipment to provide specific precautions.

SHOCK HAZARD: Labels may be on or inside the equipment, for example, a drive or motor, to alert people that dangerous
voltage may be present.

BURN HAZARD: Labels may be on or inside the equipment, for example, a drive or motor, to alert people that surfaces may
reach dangerous temperatures.

ARC FLASH HAZARD: Labels may be on or inside the equipment, for example, a motor control center, to alert people to
potential Arc Flash. Arc Flash will cause severe injury or death. Wear proper Personal Protective Equipment (PPE). Follow ALL
Regulatory requirements for safe work practices and for Personal Protective Equipment (PPE).

The following icon may appear in the text of this document.

Identifies information that is useful and can help to make a process easier to do or easier to understand.

Rockwell Automation recognizes that some of the terms that are currently used in our industry and in this publication are not in alignment
with the movement toward inclusive language in technology. We are proactively collaborating with industry peers to find alternatives to such
terms and making changes to our products and content. Please excuse the use of such terms in our content while we implement
these changes.

2 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Table of Contents

Preface
About This Publication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Download Firmware, AOP, EDS, and Other Files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Summary of Changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Abbreviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Additional Resources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11

Chapter 1
CompactLogix 5370 Controllers CompactLogix 5370 Control System Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Overview Controller Functionality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
Support for Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Electronic Keying . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
More Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Example System Configurations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
EtherNet/IP Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
DeviceNet Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20

Chapter 2
Install the CompactLogix 5370 Before You Begin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
L1 Controller CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Install the Secure Digital Card. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Install the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Mount the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Ground the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Install the Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Install the Removable Terminal Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Connect Power to the Controller (Series B and C). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Connect to the Controller Via a USB Cable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Connect the Controller to an EtherNet/IP Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Connecting to Different EtherNet/IP Network Topologies. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37

Chapter 3
Install the CompactLogix 5370 Before You Begin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
L2 Controller CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller Parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Install the Secure Digital Card. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Install the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Mount the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Ground the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Install the Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Remove and Replace the Removable Terminal Block. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Wire the Terminal Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Wire Size and Terminal Screw Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Connect Power to the Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Connect to the Controller Via a USB Cable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Connect the Controller to an EtherNet/IP Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 3


Table of Contents

Connecting to Different EtherNet/IP Network Topologies. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56

Chapter 4
Install the CompactLogix 5370 Before You Begin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
L3 Controller CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller Parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Install the Secure Digital Card. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Install the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Assemble the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
Remove and Replace the Removable Terminal Block. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Wire the Terminal Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Wire Size and Terminal Screw Torque . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Mount the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Ground the System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Connect Power to the Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Connect to the Controller Via a USB Cable. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Connect the Controller to an EtherNet/IP Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Connecting to Different EtherNet/IP Network Topologies. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72

Chapter 5
Complete Software Tasks Set the IP Address of a Controller. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Required at CompactLogix 5370 Use the BOOTP Server to Set the IP Address of the Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Use the DHCP Server to Set the IP Address of the Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Controller Installation
Use RSLinx Classic Software to Set the Controller IP Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
Use the Logix Designer Application to Set the IP Address of the Controller . . . . . 82
Use the SD Card to Set the IP Address of the Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Change the IP Address of a Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Change the Network IP Address with RSLinx Classic Software. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Change the Network IP Address with Logix Designer Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Change the Network IP Address with an SD Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Load the Controller Firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Use the ControlFLASH Software to Load Firmware. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Use AutoFlash to Load Firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Use the Secure Digital Card to Load Firmware . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Select the Operating Mode of the Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97

4 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Table of Contents

Chapter 6
Communicate Over Networks EtherNet/IP Network Communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Available Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
EtherNet/IP Network Functionality. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Nodes on an EtherNet/IP Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
EtherNet/IP Network Topologies. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Socket Interface with CompactLogix 5370 Controllers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Quality of Service (QoS) and I/O Module Connections. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
EtherNet/IP Network Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
DeviceNet Network Communication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Available Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Compact I/O 1769-SDN DeviceNet Scanner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Power Supply Distance Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Current Capacity in CompactLogix 5370 L3 Control Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116

Chapter 7
Use I/O Modules with Select I/O Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
CompactLogix 5370 Connect Field Power to I/O Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Embedded I/O Modules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
L1 Controllers
Local Expansion Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Distributed I/O Modules over an EtherNet/IP Network. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Validate I/O Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Set the Number of Local Expansion Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Empty Slots and Removal and Insertion Under Power Situations. . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Estimate Requested Packet Interval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Module Faults Related to RPI Estimates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Calculate System Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Physical Placement of I/O Modules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Use the Event Task. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Configure I/O. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Common Configuration Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
I/O Connections. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Configure Distributed I/O Modules on an EtherNet/IP Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
Monitor I/O Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Bus Off Detection and Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144

Chapter 8
Use I/O Modules with Select I/O Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
CompactLogix 5370 Embedded I/O Modules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Determine Embedded Module Update Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
L2 Controllers
Channel Update Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Embedded Analog I/O Modules Data Arrays. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Input Array . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Output Array. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Configuration Array. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Local Expansion Modules - Optional . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Distributed I/O Modules over an EtherNet/IP Network. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Distributed I/O Modules over a DeviceNet Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 5


Table of Contents

Validate I/O Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175


Estimate Requested Packet Interval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Module Fault Related to RPI Estimates. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
System Power Availability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Power Supply Distance Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Configure Local I/O Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Configure Embedded I/O Modules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Configure Local Expansion Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Common Configuration Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
I/O Connections. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Configure Distributed I/O Modules on an EtherNet/IP Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Configure Distributed I/O Modules on a DeviceNet Network. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Monitor I/O Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
End Cap Detection and Module Faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188

Chapter 9
Use I/O Modules with Select I/O Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
CompactLogix 5370 Local Expansion Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Distributed I/O Modules over an EtherNet/IP Network. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
L3 Controllers
Distributed I/O Modules over a DeviceNet Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Validate I/O Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Estimate Requested Packet Interval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Module Fault Related to RPI Estimates. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Calculate System Power Consumption. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Physical Placement of I/O Modules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Power Supply Distance Rating. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Configure I/O. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Common Configuration Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
I/O Connections. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Configure Distributed I/O Modules on an EtherNet/IP Network . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Configure Distributed I/O Modules on a DeviceNet Network. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Monitor I/O Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
End Cap Detection and Module Faults . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209

Chapter 10
Develop Applications Elements of a Control Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Tasks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Task Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Scheduled and Unscheduled Programs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Routines. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Tags . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Extended Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Access Extended Properties in Logic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Programming Languages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Add-On Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
Access the Module Object . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Create the Add-On Instruction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Monitoring Controller Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
6 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023
Table of Contents

Monitoring I/O Connections. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224


I/O Communication Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
I/O Communication Timeout to a Specific I/O Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Interrupt the Execution of Logic and Execute the Fault Handler . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
System Overhead Time Slice. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Configure the System Overhead Time Slice. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
Sample Controller Projects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229

Chapter 11
Develop Integrated Motion Over Motion Axes Support. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
an EtherNet/IP Network AXIS_VIRTUAL Axis. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
AXIS_CIP_DRIVE Axis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
Application
Maximum Number of Position Loop-configured Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Position Loop-configured Drive Limits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
Time Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Configure Integrated Motion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
Enable Time Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
Add a Drive. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Scalability in Applications Using Integrated Motion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
1769-L18ERM-BB1B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240

Chapter 12
Use a Secure Digital Card Store or Load a Project with the Secure Digital Card. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Store a Project . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Load a Project . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245

Appendix A
Troubleshoot the Module Use Logix Designer Application for Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Fault Type Determination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Use the CompactLogix 5370 Controllers Status Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250

Appendix B
Replacement Considerations Product Comparison. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Power Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Embedded DC Input Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Firmware Compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Power Supply Wiring. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Series B and C Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Series A Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 7


Table of Contents

Appendix C
Connect Power to the Series A Connect External Power to Series A L1 Controllers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
CompactLogix 5370 L1 Connect Field Power to Series A L1 Controllers for I/O Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Controllers
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265

8 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Preface

About This Publication This manual describes the necessary tasks to install, configure, program, and operate a
CompactLogix™ 5370 controller. This manual is intended for automation engineers and control
system developers.

CompactLogix 5370 controllers are designed to provide solutions for small and medium-sized
applications.

Rockwell Automation recognizes that some of the terms that are currently used in our industry
and in this publication aren’t in alignment with the movement toward inclusive language in
technology. We’re proactively collaborating with industry peers to find alternatives to such
terms and making changes to our products and content. Please excuse the use of such terms
in our content while we implement these changes.

Download Firmware, AOP, Download firmware, associated files (such as AOP, EDS, and DTM), and access product release
notes from the Product Compatibility and Download Center at rok.auto/pcdc.
EDS, and Other Files

Summary of Changes This publication contains the following new or updated information. This list includes
substantive updates only and is not intended to reflect all changes.
Topic Page
Added conformal coated controller catalog numbers Throughout
Updated to include CompactLogix 5370 L1 series C controller information Throughout
Updated to include CompactLogix 5370 L2 series B controller information Throughout
Updated CompactLogix 5370 L3 controller information Throughout
Added information regarding battery-less, embedded Energy Storage Module (ESM) 35, 54, 71

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 9


Abbreviations This table lists the abbreviations that this manual uses.
Abbreviation Full Term
BOOTP Bootstrap Protocol
CIP™ Common Industrial Protocol
CJC Cold Junction Composition
COS Change of state
CST Coordinated System Time
DHCP Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol
DINT Signed double integer
DLR Device Level Ring
GSV Get System Value
HMI Human Machine Interface
IOT Immediate Output
IP Internet Protocol
JSR Jump to Subroutine
MCR Master Control Relay
MSG Message
NEC National Electrical Code
QoS Quality of Service
RPI Requested packet interval
RTB Removable terminal block
RTD Resistance Temperature Detector
RUIP Removal and insertion under power
SD Secure Digital
SELV Safety Extra Low Voltage
SINT Signed short integer
SNMP Simple Network Management Protocol
SSV Set System Value
TCP Transmission Control Protocol
USB Universal Serial Bus
UTC Coordinated Universal Time

10 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Additional Resources These documents contain additional information concerning related products from Rockwell
Automation. You can view or download publications at rok.auto/literature.
Resource Description
CompactLogix System Selection Guide, publication 1769-SG001 Describes available components for selecting a CompactLogix system
CompactLogix Controllers Specifications Technical Data, publication 1769-TD005 Provides CompactLogix controller specifications for all CompactLogix controllers
1769 Compact I/O Modules Specifications Technical Data, publication 1769-TD006 Provides specifications for all 1769 Compact I/O™ Modules
CompactLogix Communication Modules Specifications Technical Data, Provides specifications for all CompactLogix Communication Modules
publication 1769-TD007
CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers Installation Instructions, publication 1769-IN029 Describes how to install CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers
CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers Installation Instructions, publication 1769-IN090 Describes how to install CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers
CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers Installation Instructions, publication 1769-IN023 Describes how to install CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers
Armor CompactLogix Controllers Installation Instructions, publication 1769-IN021 Describes how to install the Armor™ CompactLogix controllers
Electronic Keying in Logix 5000 Control Systems Application Technique, Describes the types of Electronic Keying available in Logix 5000™ control systems
publication LOGIX-AT001
Execution Time and Memory Use for Logix 5000 Controller Instructions Reference Helps estimate the memory use and execution time of programmed logic and in
Manual, publication 1756-RM087 selecting among different programming options.
Integrated Motion on the EtherNet/IP Network: Configuration and Startup User Describes how to configure an Integrated Motion over EtherNet/IP™ motion
Manual, publication MOTION-UM003 application and to start up that motion solution in a Logix 5000 control system
Logix 5000 Controllers Common Procedures Programming Manual, Provides links to a collection of programming manuals that describe how you can use
publication 1756-PM001 procedures that are common to all Logix 5000 controller projects
Logix 5000 Controllers General Instructions Reference Manual, Provides details about each available instruction for a Logix-based controller
publication 1756-RM003
Provides guidance on how to conduct security assessments, implement Rockwell
System Security Design Guidelines Reference Manual, publication SECURE-RM001 Automation products in a secure system, harden the control system, manage user
access, and dispose of equipment
Industrial Automation Wiring and Grounding Guidelines, publication 1770-4.1 Provides general guidelines for installing a Rockwell Automation industrial system

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 11


Notes:

12 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 1

CompactLogix 5370 Controllers Overview

The CompactLogix™ 5370 controllers offer state-of-the-art control, communication, and I/O
elements in a distributed control package. This product family includes the following
CompactLogix 5370 controllers:
• 1769-L16ER-BB1B
• 1769-L18ER-BB1B
• 1769-L18ERM-BB1B, 1769-L18ERM-BB1BK
• 1769-L19ER-BB1B, 1769-L19ER-BB1BK
• 1769-L24ER-QB1B
• 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B, 1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK
• 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B
• 1769-L30ER, 1769-L30ERK
• 1769-L30ERM, 1769-L30ERMK
• 1769-L30ER-NSE
• 1769-L33ER, 1769-L33ERK
• 1769-L33ERM, 1769-L33ERMK
• 1769-L33ERMO
• 1769-L36ERM
• 1769-L36ERMO
• 1769-L37ERM, 1769-L37ERMK
• 1769-L37ERMO(1)
• 1769-L38ERM, 1769-L38ERMK
• 1769-L38ERMO(1)
Among the features the CompactLogix 5370 controllers support, are dual EtherNet/IP™ ports
on each controller and support for Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP network on some
CompactLogix 5370 controllers.

The Armor™ CompactLogix controller, 1769-L33ERMO, 1769-L36ERMO, 1769-L37ERMO, or 1769-


L38ERMO, combines the CompactLogix controller with a power supply in an IP67-rated housing
for mounting on a machine. For information on how to install the Armor CompactLogix
controller, see the Armor CompactLogix Controller Installation Instructions, publication
1769-IN021.

(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 13


Chapter 1 CompactLogix 5370 Controllers Overview

CompactLogix 5370 Control This table describes the components a CompactLogix 5370 controller uses in a typical
control system.
System Components
Product Family
System Component
CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers
Controller One of the controllers that is documented in this publication
One of the following 1769 Compact I/O™
External power supply that is connected to power supplies:
External power supply that is connected to the • 1769-PA2, 1769-PA2K
the embedded 24V DC nominal input of the
Power supply embedded 24V DC input of the controller, isolated
controller, nonisolated power supply. The • 1769-PB2, 1769-PB2K
power supply
power supply has a 10…28.8 input range. • 1769-PA4, 1769-PA4K
• 1769-PB4, 1769-PB4K
Any of the following: Any of the following:
• EtherNet/IP network via built-in EtherNet/ • EtherNet/IP network via built-in EtherNet/IP network ports
Communication
networks components IP network ports • DeviceNet® network via a 1769-SDN module
• USB connection only for programming and
firmware updates • USB connection only for programming and firmware updates
• One of the following:
– RSLogix 5000® software, version 20.xx.xx, - For CompactLogix 5370 controllers that are using firmware revision 20.xxx
– Logix Designer application, version 21.00.00 or later, - For CompactLogix 5370 controllers that are using firmware revision 21.000 or later
Software • RSLinx® Classic software, version 2.59.xx or later
• RSNetWorx™ for DeviceNet software, version 11.00.00 or later
IMPORTANT: This software isn’t used with CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers because they do not offer DeviceNet connectivity.
Secure Digital (SD) • 1784-SD1 card - Ships with CompactLogix 5370 controller and offers 1 GB of memory
card for external
nonvolatile memory • 1784-SD2 card - Available for separate purchase and offers 2 GB of memory
• 16 embedded 24V DC digital input points
• 16 embedded 24V DC digital input points -
The nominal input voltage is 24V DC but • 16 embedded 24V DC digital output points
the operating range is 10…28.8V DC. • Only 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B and
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers • Local expansion modules- 1769 Compact I/
• 16 embedded 24V DC digital output points O modules
- The nominal input voltage is 24V DC but – Four embedded high-speed counters
I/O modules the operating range is 10…28.8V DC. – Four embedded universal analog input points • Distributed I/O - Multiple I/O module
– Two embedded analog output points product lines over DeviceNet and
• Local expansion modules- 1734 POINT I/O™ EtherNet/IP networks
modules • Local expansion modules- 1769 Compact
I/O modules
• Distributed I/O - Multiple I/O module
product lines over an EtherNet/IP network • Distributed I/O - Multiple I/O module product lines
over DeviceNet and EtherNet/IP networks
Reset button If held in during controller power-up, it clears the user program from the internal memory of the controller.

14 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 1 CompactLogix 5370 Controllers Overview

Controller Functionality This table describes the functionality available with CompactLogix 5370 controllers.
Controller Programs EtherNet/IP
Internal Energy Power Supply Onboard User Local I/O Module
Cat. No. Tasks Supported Per Network
Storage Solution Topology Support Distance Rating Memory Size Support
Supported Task
As many as six
1769-L16ER-BB1B 384 KB 1734 POINT I/O
modules(1)
1769-L18ER-BB1B
NA
1769-L18ERM-BB1B, 512 KB As many as eight
1769-L18ERM-BB1BK 1734 POINT I/O
1769-L19ER-BB1B, modules(1)
1 MB
1769-L19ER-BB1BK
1769-L24ER-QB1B
768 KB As many as four
1769-L24ER-QBFC1B,
1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK See footnote(2) Compact I/O
modules
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Support the 1 MB
1769-L30ER, 1769-L30ERK following
Yes - Eliminating topologies: As many as eight
1769-L30ER-NSE 32 1000 the need for a • Device Level 1 MB Compact I/O
1769-L30ERM, 1769-L30ERMK battery Ring (DLR) modules
1769-L33ER, 1769-L33ERK • Linear As many as 16
• Traditional star Compact I/O
1769-L33ERM, 1769-L33ERMK 2 MB modules
1769-L33ERMO —
4 As many as 30
1769-L36ERM Compact I/O
3 MB modules
1769-L36ERMO
1769-L37ERM, 1769-L37ERMK
4 MB
1769-L37ERMO(3) —
1769-L38ERM, 1769-L38ERMK
5 MB
1769-L38ERMO(3)
(1) IMPORTANT: You can use up to the maximum number of 1734 POINT I/O modules with the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers that are listed in the table in Chapter 2, page 24. This applies only
as long as the total current that the modules draw does not exceed the available POINTBus™ backplane current of 1 A. If you must use more local expansion modules than the POINTBus
backplane current supports, you can install a 1734-EP24DC POINT I/O expansion power supply between local expansion modules to increase the POINTBus backplane power and meet your
system requirements.
(2) CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers have an embedded power supply. Therefore, you do not need to consider the power supply distance rating when installing the controller. The Compact I/O
modules that are used as local expansion modules in a CompactLogix 5370 L2 control systems operate on a CompactBus. These Compact I/O modules also have a power supply distance
rating that you must consider when installing those modules.
For more information on power supply distance rating regarding how to use Compact I/O modules in a CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system, see Chapter 8, page 177.
(3) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 15


Chapter 1 CompactLogix 5370 Controllers Overview

The 1769-L30ER-NSE controller is intended for use in applications that require the installed
controller to deplete its residual stored energy to specific levels before transporting it into or
out of your application.

WARNING: If your application requires the 1769-L30ER-NSE controller to deplete


its residual stored energy to 200 µJ or fewer before you transport it into or out of
the application, complete these steps before you remove the controller.
1. Turn off power to the chassis.
After you turn off power, the OK status indicator on the controller transitions from Green to Steady
Red to OFF.
2. Wait at least 15 minutes for the residual stored energy to decrease to 200 µJ or fewer before you
remove the controller.
There’s no visual indication of when the 15 minutes has expired. You must
track that time period.

IMPORTANT The Real Time Clock (RTC) does not retain its time and date when the
power is off.

Some applications require that the installed controller to deplete its residual stored energy to
specific levels before transporting it into or out of your application. This requirement can
include other devices that also require a wait time before removing them. See the
documentation of those products for more information.

Support for Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP Network


The following CompactLogix 5370 controllers support Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP
network:
• 1769-L18ERM-BB1B, 1769-L18ERM-BB1BK
• 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B
• 1769-L30ERM, 1769-L30ERMK
• 1769-L33ERM, 1769-L33ERMK
• 1769-L33ERMO
• 1769-L36ERM
• 1769-L36ERMO
• 1769-L37ERM, 1769-L37ERMK
• 1769-L37ERMO(1)
• 1769-L38ERM, 1769-L38ERMK
• 1769-L38ERMO(1)

For more information on how to use CompactLogix 5370 controllers in applications that
require Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP network, see Chapter 11, page 231.

(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

16 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 1 CompactLogix 5370 Controllers Overview

Electronic Keying Electronic Keying reduces the possibility that you use the wrong device in a control system. It
compares the device that is defined in your project to the installed device. If keying fails, a
fault occurs.
Electronic Keying Attributes
Attribute Description
Vendor The device manufacturer.
Device Type The general type of the product, for example, digital I/O module.
Product Code The specific type of the product. The Product Code maps to a catalog number.
Major Revision A number that represents the functional capabilities of a device.
Minor Revision A number that represents behavior changes in the device.

Electronic Keying Options


Keying Option Description
Lets the installed device accept the key of the device that is defined in the project when the
installed device can emulate the defined device. With Compatible Module, you can typically
replace a device with another device that has the following characteristics:
• Same catalog number
Compatible Module
• Same or higher Major Revision
• Minor Revision as follows:
– If the Major Revision is the same, the Minor Revision must be the same or higher.
– If the Major Revision is higher, the Minor Revision can be any number.
Indicates that the keying attributes aren’t considered when attempting to communicate
with a device. With Disable Keying, communication can occur with a device other than the
type specified in the project.
ATTENTION: Be extremely cautious when using Disable Keying; if used incorrectly, this
Disable Keying option can lead to personal injury or death, property damage, or economic loss.
We strongly recommend that you do not use Disable Keying.
If you use Disable Keying, you must take full responsibility for understanding whether the
device being used can fulfill the functional requirements of the application.
Indicates that all keying attributes must match to establish communication. If any attribute
Exact Match does not match precisely, communication with the device does not occur.

Carefully consider the implications of each keying option when selecting one.

IMPORTANT Changing Electronic Keying parameters online interrupts connections


to the device and any devices that are connected through the device.
Connections from other controllers can also be broken.
If an I/O connection to a device is interrupted, the result can be a loss
of data.

More Information
For more detailed information on Electronic Keying, see Electronic Keying in Logix 5000™
Control Systems Application Technique, publication LOGIX-AT001.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 17


Chapter 1 CompactLogix 5370 Controllers Overview

Example System CompactLogix 5370 controllers support the following networks:


Configurations • EtherNet/IP network - All CompactLogix 5370 controllers
• DeviceNet network - Only CompactLogix 5370 L2 and L3 controllers

EtherNet/IP Network

IMPORTANT In addition to using CompactLogix 5370 controllers in a DLR network


topology on an EtherNet/IP network, you can also use them in linear or
star EtherNet/IP network topologies.
For more information on the other EtherNet/IP network topologies, see
Chapter6, page 99.
Some of the CompactLogix 5370 controllers support Integrated Motion
over an EtherNet/IP network, if desired. For more information on using
Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP network, see Chapter 11,
page 231.

Example 1769-L18ERM-BB1B Control System Configuration on an EtherNet/IP Network


Stratix® 5700 1769-L18ERM-BB1B

Kinetix® 5500 PanelView™ Plus 7

1734-AENTR POINT I/O 1794-AENTR FLEX™ I/O

Kinetix 5500

18 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 1 CompactLogix 5370 Controllers Overview

Example 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Control System Configuration on an EtherNet/IP Network


• 1769-AENTR
Stratix 5700 • 1769 Compact I/O 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B

PowerFlex® 525
PanelView™ Plus 7

1734-AENTR POINT I/O 1794-AENTR FLEX I/O


Kinetix 5500

Example 1769-L33ERM Control System Configuration on an EtherNet/IP Network

• 1769-AENTR
Stratix 5700 • 1769 Compact I/O 1769-L33ERM Control System

Kinetix 5500
PanelView Plus 7

Kinetix 5500
1734-AENTR POINT I/O 1794-AENTR FLEX I/O

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 19


Chapter 1 CompactLogix 5370 Controllers Overview

DeviceNet Network

IMPORTANT CompactLogix 5370 L2 and L3 controllers can send messages to


devices on the DeviceNet network; however, these controllers can’t
receive messages from those devices on the DeviceNet network.

Example 1769-L24ER-QB1B Control System Configuration on a DeviceNet Network


• 1769-L24ER-QB1B
DeviceNet Connection • 1769-SDN Scanner

1606-XLDNET E3™ Electronic • 1734-ADN POINT I/O


Overload Relay • POINT I/O

Figure 1 - Example 1769-L33ERM Control System Configuration on a DeviceNet Network


• 1769-L33ERM
DeviceNet Connection
• 1769-SDN Scanner

E3 Electronic
Overload Relay

• 1734-ADN POINT I/O


1606-XLDNET
• POINT I/O

For more information on how to use the CompactLogix 5370 L2 or L3 controllers on DeviceNet
networks, see Chapter 6, page 111.

20 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 2

Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

Environment and Enclosure


ATTENTION: This equipment is intended for use in a Pollution Degree 2 industrial environment, in overvoltage Category II
applications (as defined in EN/IEC 60664-1), at altitudes up to 2000 m (6562 ft) without derating.
This equipment isn’t intended for use in residential environments and may not provide adequate protection to radio
communication services in such environments.
This equipment is supplied as open-type equipment. It must be mounted within an enclosure that is suitably designed for
those specific environmental conditions that will be present and appropriately designed to prevent personal injury resulting
from accessibility to live parts. The enclosure must have suitable flame-retardant properties to prevent or minimize the
spread of flame, complying with a flame spread rating of 5VA or be approved for application if nonmetallic. The interior of
the enclosure must be accessible only by the use of a tool. Subsequent sections of this publication may contain additional
information regarding specific enclosure-type ratings that are required to comply with certain product safety certifications.
In addition to this publication, see the following:
• Industrial Automation Wiring and Grounding Guidelines, publication 1770-4.1 for more installation requirements
• NEMA 250 and EN/IEC 60529, as applicable, for explanations of the degrees of protection provided by enclosure

North American Hazardous Location Approval


The following information applies when operating this Informations sur l’utilisation de cet équipement en
equipment in hazardous locations. environnements dangereux.
Products marked "CL I, DIV 2, GP A, B, C, D" are suitable for use in Les produits marqués "CL I, DIV 2, GP A, B, C, D" ne conviennent
qu'à une utilisation en environnements de Classe I Division 2
Class I Division 2 Groups A, B, C, D, Hazardous Locations and Groupes A, B, C, D dangereux et non dangereux. Chaque produit
nonhazardous locations only. Each product is supplied with
markings on the rating nameplate indicating the hazardous est livré avec des marquages sur sa plaque d'identification qui
indiquent le code de température pour les environnements
location temperature code. When combining products within a dangereux. Lorsque plusieurs produits sont combinés dans un
system, the most adverse temperature code (lowest "T"
number) may be used to help determine the overall temperature système, le code de température le plus défavorable (code de
température le plus faible) peut être utilisé pour déterminer le
code of the system. Combinations of equipment in your system code de température global du système. Les combinaisons
are subject to investigation by the local Authority Having
Jurisdiction at the time of installation. d'équipements dans le système sont sujettes à inspection par
les autorités locales qualifiées au moment de l'installation.
WARNING: ?EXPLOSION HAZARD - WARNING: ?RISQUE D’EXPLOSION -
• Do not disconnect equipment unless power has • Couper le courant ou s'assurer que
been removed or the area is known to be l'environnement est classé non dangereux avant
nonhazardous. de débrancher l'équipement.
• Do not disconnect connections to this equipment • Couper le courant ou s'assurer que
unless power has been removed or the area is l'environnement est classé non dangereux avant
known to be nonhazardous. Secure any external de débrancher les connecteurs. Fixer tous les
connections that mate to this equipment by connecteurs externes reliés à cet équipement à
using screws, sliding latches, threaded l'aide de vis, loquets coulissants, connecteurs
connectors, or other means provided with this filetés ou autres moyens fournis avec ce produit.
product. • La substitution de composants peut rendre cet
• Substitution of components may impair équipement inadapté à une utilisation en
suitability for Class I, Division 2. environnement de Classe I, Division 2.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 21


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

UK and European Hazardous Location Approval


The following applies to products marked II 3 G. Such products:
• are Equipment Group II, Equipment Category 3, and comply with the Essential Health and Safety Requirements relating to the design
and construction of such equipment given in Schedule 1 of UKEX Regulation 2016 No. 1107 and Annex II to EU Directive 2014/34/EU. See
the UKEX and EU Declaration of Conformity at rok.auto/certifications for details.
• provide protection type II 3 G Ex ec IIC T4 Gc according to EN IEC 60079-7.
• comply to Standards: EN IEC 60079-0:2018, EN IEC 60079-7:2015+A1:2018 reference certificate number UL 21 ATEX 2603X and
UL22UKEX2515X.
• are intended for use in areas in which explosive atmospheres caused by gases, vapors, mists, or air are unlikely to occur, or are likely
to occur only infrequently and for short periods. Such locations correspond to Zone 2 classification according to UKEX regulation 2016
No. 1107 and ATEX directive 2014/34/EU.

Special Considerations for Safe Use


WARNING: ?
• The equipment shall be mounted in an UKEX/ATEX Zone 2 certified enclosure with a minimum ingress protection rating of at
least IP54 (in accordance with EN IEC 60079-0) and used in an environment of not more than Pollution Degree 2 (as defined
in EN/IEC 60664-1). The enclosure must be accessible only by the use of a tool.
• This equipment must be used within its specified ratings that are defined by Rockwell Automation.
• Provisions shall be made to prevent the rated voltage from being exceeded by transient disturbances of more than 140% of
the peak rated voltage when applied in Zone 2 environments.
• Secure any external connections that mate to this equipment by using screws, sliding latches, threaded connectors, or other
means provided with this product.
• Do not disconnect equipment unless power has been removed or the area is known to be nonhazardous.
• Enclosure must be marked with the following: “Warning - Do not open when energized.” After installation of equipment into
the enclosure, access to termination compartments must be dimensioned so that conductors can be readily connected.
• The instructions in the user manual shall be observed.
• This equipment must be used only with UKEX/ATEX certified Rockwell Automation backplanes.
• Earthing is accomplished through mounting of modules on rail.

Prevent Electrostatic Discharge


ATTENTION: This equipment is sensitive to electrostatic discharge, which can cause internal damage and affect normal
operation. Follow these guidelines when you handle this equipment:
• Touch a grounded object to discharge potential static.
• Wear an approved grounding wriststrap.
• Do not touch connectors or pins on component boards.
• Do not touch circuit components inside the equipment.
• Use a static-safe workstation, if available.
• Store the equipment in appropriate static-safe packaging when not in use.

22 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

Before You Begin The CompactLogix™ 5370 L1 series B and C controller redesign occurred to provide an option
to use one external power supply for system power and field side power.

There are differences between the CompactLogix 5370 L1, series A and B, controllers, which
are detailed throughout the sections of this manual.

Consider the details in this section before installing a CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller.

ATTENTION: If this equipment is used in a manner not specified by the


manufacturer, the protection provided by the equipment can be impaired.

• The control system includes the controller, an embedded power supply, and embedded
I/O points.

Removable Connector for


Embedded Power Supply

Embedded I/O Module

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 23


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

• The embedded power supply for the series A L16ER, L18ER, or L18ERM controller is a 24V
DC nominal, non-isolated power supply with an input range of 10…28.8V DC. You wire
the embedded power supply via a removable connector.
• The embedded power supply for the series B and C L16ER, L18ER, and L18ERM
controllers, and the series A and C L19ER controller is a 24V DC nominal, isolated
power supply. The input range of the power supply is 10…28.8V DC. You wire the
embedded power supply via a removable connector.

IMPORTANT You must use a dedicated external Class 2/SELV-approved power


supply to provide power to the system, according to the needs of
the application, and within the operating voltage range of the
controller for only series A L16ER, L18ER, and L18ERM controllers.
You can’t use the external power supply that provides power to
the embedded power supply of the controller to provide power to
any other components or devices in the application for only
series A L16ER, L18ER, and L18ERM controllers.
• A second, fused external power supply must be used to provide power to other
components for only series A L16ER, L18ER, and L18ERM controllers (see Appendix C,
page 257).
• Power for other components can be provided from the external power supply that is
used to provide power to the system for only series B and C L16ER, L18ER, L18ERM
controllers, and series A and C L19ER controllers.
• The controller has 16 embedded digital input points and 16 embedded digital output
points. You wire the input and output points via a removable connector.
• The controller supports the use of a limited number of 1734 POINT I/O modules on the
POINTBus™ backplane as local expansion modules.

IMPORTANT You must use the latest series and firmware revision for all 1734
POINT I/O modules in the local expansion slots to make sure that
your application operates as expected. Use of an older firmware
revision renders the entire 1734 bus inoperable.
This table lists local expansion module support by controller catalog number.
Local Expansion Module Support for CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers
Cat. No. 1734 POINT I/O Modules Supported, Max
1769-L16ER-BB1B 6
1769-L18ER-BB1B
1769-L18ERM-BB1B,
1769-L18ERM-BB1BK 8
1769-L19ER-BB1B,
1769-L19ER-BB1BK

See Chapter 7, page 117 for further information about the I/O modules.

ATTENTION: Do not discard the end cap. Use this end cap to cover the
exposed interconnections on the last mounting base on the DIN rail. Failure to
do so could result in equipment damage or injury from electric shock.
For more information on how to terminate the end of your system, see
page 31.

1734 POINT I/O modules support removal and insertion under power.

24 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller Parts


These parts are included in the box when you order your controller:
• Controller - Specific catalog number varies by order
• 1784-SD1 Secure Digital (SD) card with 1 GB of memory storage
A 1784-SD2 SD card with 2 GB of memory storage, or more 1784-SD1 SD cards, are also
available if you need extra memory.

IMPORTANT The life expectancy of nonvolatile media is dependent on the


number of write cycles that are performed. Nonvolatile media
use a wear leveling technique or technology for prolonging the
service life, but avoid frequent writes.
Avoid frequent writes when logging data. We recommend that
you log data to a buffer in the memory of your controller and
limit the number of times data is written to removable media.
• An end cap protective cover that slides onto the right side of the CompactLogix 5370 L1
control system.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 25


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

Install the Secure The CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller is shipped from the factory with the 1784-SD1 SD card
installed.
Digital Card
Complete these steps to reinstall an SD card that has been removed from the controller back
into the controller or to install a new SD card into the controller.

We recommend that you leave the SD card in the controller, even when it isn’t used. If the
controller experiences a major non-recoverable fault, extended fault information is saved to
the card.

WARNING: W ? hen you insert or remove the SD card while power is on, an electric
arc can occur. This could cause an explosion in hazardous location installations.
Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous before
proceeding.
1. Verify that the SD card is locked or unlocked according to your preference.
Consider that, if the card is unlocked, the controller can write data to it or read data
from it.

Unlocked Locked

2. Open the door for the SD card.

26 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

3. Insert the SD card into the SD card slot.


You can install the SD card in only one orientation. The beveled corner is at the top.
If you feel resistance when inserting the SD card, pull it out and change the orientation.
4. Gently press the card until it clicks into place.

5. Close the SD card door.

We recommend that you keep the SD card door closed during normal system operation.
For more information on how to use the SD card, see Chapter 12, page 241.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 27


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

Install the System Complete these steps to install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 control system.

Mount the System


You mount a CompactLogix 5370 L1 control system on a DIN rail. Before you complete the steps
that are required to install the system, install a DIN rail.

WARNING: W ? hen used in a Class I, Division 2, hazardous location, this


equipment must be mounted in a suitable enclosure with proper wiring method
that complies with the governing electrical codes.

Available DIN Rails

ATTENTION: This product is grounded through the DIN rail to chassis ground.
Use zinc plated chromate-passivated steel DIN rail to assure proper
grounding. The use of other DIN rail materials (for example, aluminum or
plastic) that can corrode, oxidize, or are poor conductors, can result in
improper or intermittent grounding. Secure DIN rail to mounting surface
approximately every 200 mm (7.8 in.) and use end-anchors appropriately. Be
sure to ground the DIN rail properly. Refer to Industrial Automation Wiring and
Grounding Guidelines, Rockwell Automation publication 1770-4.1, for more
information.
You can mount the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller on these DIN rails:
• EN 50 022 - 35 x 7.5 mm (1.38 x 0.30 in.)
• EN 50 022 - 35 x 15 mm (1.38 x 0.59 in.)

IMPORTANT You must install bumpers on the back of your CompactLogix


5370 L1 controller before mounting it on the EN 50022 - 35 x 15
mm (1.38 x 0.59 in.) DIN rail.
For more information about which bumpers to order, see
Knowledgebase Technote, 5370 L16ER/L18ER recommended
Bumpers for use with 1.38 x 0.59 in. DIN rail.

Minimum Spacing

Maintain spacing from enclosure walls, wireways, and adjacent equipment. Allow 50 mm (2 in.)
of space on all sides, as shown. This spacing provides ventilation and electrical isolation.

50 mm
Top (2 in.)

50 mm 50 mm
CompactLogix 5370 L1

Supply and I/O Module

1734 POINT I/O Module

1734 POINT I/O Module

1734 POINT I/O Module

(2 in.) (2 in.)
Embedded Power
Controller with

End Cap

Side Side

Bottom 50 mm
(2 in.)

28 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

System Dimensions
CompactLogix 5370 L1 Control System Dimensions

105 mm 100.00 mm
(4.13 in.) (3.94 in.)

130.00 mm
(5.11 in.)

144.00 mm
(5.67 in.)

CompactLogix 5370 L1 Control System Dimensions with Expansion I/O Modules Installed
12.00 mm
(0.47 in.)

105 mm 100.00 mm
(4.13 in.) (3.94 in.)

130.00 mm
(5.11 in.)

144.00 mm
(5.67 in.)

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 29


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

Ground the System

ATTENTION: This product is intended to be mounted to a well-grounded


mounting surface such as a metal panel. Additional grounding connections
from the power supply's mounting tabs or DIN rail (if used) aren’t required
unless the mounting surface can’t be grounded.
See Industrial Automation Wiring and Grounding Guidelines, Rockwell
Automation publication 1770-4.1, for additional information.

Install the Controller


Complete these steps to install the controller.
1. Pull out the locking tabs.

2. Slide the controller into position on the DIN rail and push the locking tabs in.

30 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

3. If you aren’t using local expansion modules, use the tongue-and-groove slots on the
right side of the controller to slide a protective covering onto the controller. The
protective cover ships with the controller.
The covering covers the exposed interconnections on the right side of the controller.
Failure to use a protective covering can result in equipment damage or injury from
electric shock.

If you’re using local expansion modules, see Chapter 7, page 127 for more information
on how to install them in a CompactLogix 5370 L1 control system.

Install the Removable Terminal Block


A removable terminal block (RTB) is supplied with your wiring base assembly. To remove, pull
up on the RTB handle. This feature allows the mounting base to be removed and replaced as
necessary without removing any wires. To reinsert the removable terminal block, proceed as
follows:
1. Insert the end opposite the handle into the base unit. This end has a curved section that
engages with the wiring base.
2. Rotate the RTB into the wiring base until it locks itself in place.
3. If an I/O module is installed, snap the RTB handle into place on the module.
tu ule
s
Sta od
M

D tus ork
Sta etw
N

E:
O
N

le
t p
pu ou
In oc
erm

Insert the module straight down


Th

into the mounting base.


IT 34
17
2I

Hook the RTB end into


the mounting base end
and rotate until it locks
into place.

WARNING: W ? hen you connect or disconnect the RTB with field-side


power applied, an electric arc can occur. This can cause an explosion in
hazardous location installations.
Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous before
proceeding.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 31


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

Connect Power to the Controller (Series B and C)


For information to connect power to a series A L1 controller, see Appendix C, page 257.

IMPORTANT This section describes how to power the controller via the VDC+ and
VDC- terminals.
Connections to the VDC+ and VDC- terminals do not provide power to
input or output devices that are connected to the embedded I/O
modules of the controller or local expansion modules. Power must be
connected to the FP+ and FP- terminals to provide power to input or
output devices that are connected to the embedded I/O modules of the
controller or local expansion modules.
The external power supply can be used to power both the VDC+/- and
FP+/- terminals on the series B and C L1 controllers.
For more information on how to provide power to input or output
devices that are connected to the embedded I/O modules of the
controller and local expansion modules, see Chapter 7, page 117.

WARNING: Do not connect directly to line voltage. Line voltage must be supplied
by a suitable, approved isolating transformer or power supply having short
circuit capacity not exceeding 100VA maximum or equivalent. The controller
power requirement is 30VA.

Power is connected to the controller via a removable connector that is connected to the front
of the controller. This graphic shows the connector.

IMPORTANT The controller is grounded once it’s installed on a DIN rail as described
on page 28.

32 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

Consider these points before completing the steps in this section:


• This section describes how to connect an external 24V DC power source to the
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller.
For information on how to provide field power to input and output devices that are
connected to the embedded I/O modules of the controller and local expansion modules
via the removable connector, see Chapter 7, page 117.
• Use a power source that most effectively meets your application needs. That is,
calculate the power requirements for your application before choosing a power source
to avoid using a power source that far exceeds your application requirements.
• This section assumes that any DIN rail that you use has been grounded following
Industrial Automation Wiring and Grounding Guidelines, publication 1770-4.1.
• The embedded power supply of the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller provides power to
the controller and POINTBus backplane.
• Not all Class 2/SELV-listed power supplies are certified for use in all applications, for
example, use in nonhazardous and hazardous environments.
Before installing an external power supply, consult all specification and certification
information to verify that you’re using an acceptable external power supply.
• Only for example purposes, this section describes how to use a 1606-XLE120E, NEC
Class 2 switched-mode power supply. The exact steps for other external power supplies
can vary from the steps that are described here.

Complete these steps to connect power to the CompactLogix series B and C L16ER, L18ER, and
L18ERM controllers, and series A and C L19ER controllers.
1. Verify that the external 24V DC power source isn’t powered.
2. Mount the external 24V DC power source on a DIN rail.
The external 24V DC power source can be installed on the same DIN rail as the controller
or a separate DIN rail.
3. Connect wires to the 24V DC+ and 24V DC- connections on the external 24V DC power
source.

WARNING: I?f you connect or disconnect wiring while the field-side power is on,
an electric arc can occur. This could cause an explosion in hazardous location
installations. Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous before
proceeding.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 33


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

4. Pull the removable connector off the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller.

5. Connect the wire that is connected to the 24V DC+ terminal on the external 24V DC
power source to the VDC+ terminal. The VDC+ terminal is the top terminal on the
removable connector.

6. Connect the wire that is connected to the 24V DC- terminal on the external 24V DC
power source to the VDC- terminal. The VDC- terminal is the second from the top on the
removable connector.

IMPORTANT If your application requires a power control device, for example,


a switch or relay, between the external 24V DC power source and
the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller to control when the
controller is powered, you must install the power control device
at the VDC+ terminal on the removable connector.
If you install the power control device at the VDC- terminal, the
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller can have problems powering up
or powering down properly.

34 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

7. Plug the removable connector back into the controller.


8. Secure the removable connector in place.

9. Turn on power to the external 24V DC power source.

This graphic shows an external 24V DC power source that is connected to a CompactLogix
5370 L1 controller.

CompactLogix 5370 Controllers have an embedded, battery-less Energy Storage


Module (ESM) that provides power to the CPU upon power-down, allowing the
controller to write customer application and tag data to the onboard nonvolatile
memory. In some cases, the ESM continues to provide enough power to keep the
wall clock active until its residual stored energy is depleted.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 35


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

Connect to the Controller The controller has a USB port that uses a Type B receptacle. The port is USB 2.0-compatible
and operates at 12 Mbps.
Via a USB Cable
Use a USB cable to connect your computer to the USB port. With this connection, you can
update firmware and download programs to the controller directly from your computer.

ATTENTION: The USB port is intended only for temporary local programming
purposes and not intended for permanent connection.
The USB cable isn’t to exceed 3.0 m (9.84 ft) and must not contain hubs.

WARNING: D? o not use the USB port in hazardous locations.

Plug the USB cable into the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller.

36 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

Connect the Controller to an


EtherNet/IP Network WARNING: I?f you connect or disconnect the communication cable with power
applied to this module or any device on the network, an electric arc can occur.
This could cause an explosion in hazardous location installations.
Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous before
proceeding.

Connect the RJ45 connector of the Ethernet cable to one of the Ethernet ports on the
controller. The ports are on the bottom of the controller.
Bottom of Controller

Port 1 - Front

Port 2 - Back

IMPORTANT This example shows how to connect the controller to the network
through one port. Depending on the network topology of your
application, you can connect both ports of the controller to the
EtherNet/IP™ network.

Connecting to Different EtherNet/IP Network Topologies


CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers have embedded switch technology and two EtherNet/IP
ports that let you use it in various EtherNet/IP network topologies:
• Device Level Ring network topology - Both ports on the controller are connected to the
network.
• Linear network topology - Both ports on the controller are connected to the network.
• Star network topology - One port on the controller is connected to the network.

There are connection and configuration requirements for each EtherNet/IP network topology.

For more information, see Chapter 6, page 99.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 37


Chapter 2 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

Notes:

38 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 3

Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

Environment and Enclosure


ATTENTION: This equipment is intended for use in a Pollution Degree 2 industrial environment, in overvoltage Category II
applications (as defined in EN IEC 60664-1), at altitudes up to 2000 m (6562 ft) without derating.
This equipment isn’t intended for use in residential environments and may not provide adequate protection to radio
communication services in such environments.
This equipment is supplied as open-type equipment. It must be mounted within an enclosure that is suitably designed for
those specific environmental conditions that will be present and appropriately designed to prevent personal injury resulting
from accessibility to live parts. The enclosure must have suitable flame-retardant properties to prevent or minimize the
spread of flame, complying with a flame spread rating of 5VA or be approved for application if nonmetallic. The interior of
the enclosure must be accessible only by the use of a tool. Subsequent sections of this publication may contain additional
information regarding specific enclosure-type ratings that are required to comply with certain product safety certifications.
In addition to this publication, see the following:
• Industrial Automation Wiring and Grounding Guidelines, publication 1770-4.1 for more installation requirements.
• NEMA 250 and EN/IEC 60529, as applicable, for explanations of the degrees of protection provided by enclosure.

North American Hazardous Location Approval


The following information applies when operating this Informations sur l’utilisation de cet équipement en
equipment in hazardous locations. environnements dangereux.
Products marked "CL I, DIV 2, GP A, B, C, D" are suitable for use Les produits marqués "CL I, DIV 2, GP A, B, C, D" ne conviennent
qu'à une utilisation en environnements de Classe I Division 2
in Class I Division 2 Groups A, B, C, D, Hazardous Locations and Groupes A, B, C, D dangereux et non dangereux. Chaque produit
nonhazardous locations only. Each product is supplied with
markings on the rating nameplate indicating the hazardous est livré avec des marquages sur sa plaque d'identification qui
indiquent le code de température pour les environnements
location temperature code. When combining products within a dangereux. Lorsque plusieurs produits sont combinés dans un
system, the most adverse temperature code (lowest "T"
number) may be used to help determine the overall système, le code de température le plus défavorable (code de
température le plus faible) peut être utilisé pour déterminer le
temperature code of the system. Combinations of equipment in code de température global du système. Les combinaisons
your system are subject to investigation by the local Authority
Having Jurisdiction at the time of installation. d'équipements dans le système sont sujettes à inspection par
les autorités locales qualifiées au moment de l'installation.
WARNING: RISQUE D’EXPLOSION -
WARNING: EXPLOSION HAZARD - • Couper le courant ou s'assurer que l'environnement
• Do not disconnect equipment unless power has
been removed or the area is known to be est classé non dangereux avant de débrancher
l'équipement.
nonhazardous. • Couper le courant ou s'assurer que l'environnement
• Do not disconnect connections to this equipment
unless power has been removed or the area is est classé non dangereux avant de débrancher les
connecteurs. Fixer tous les connecteurs externes
known to be nonhazardous. Secure any external reliés à cet équipement à l'aide de vis, loquets
connections that mate to this equipment by using
screws, sliding latches, threaded connectors, or coulissants, connecteurs filetés ou autres moyens
fournis avec ce produit.
other means provided with this product. • La substitution de composants peut rendre cet
• Substitution of components may impair suitability
for Class I, Division 2. équipement inadapté à une utilisation en
environnement de Classe I, Division 2.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 39


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

UK and European Hazardous Location Approval


The following applies to products marked II 3 G. Such products:
• Are Equipment Group II, Equipment Category 3, and comply with the Essential Health and Safety Requirements relating to the design
and construction of such equipment given in Schedule 1 of UKEX Regulation 2016 No. 1107 and Annex II to UKEX and EU Directive 2014/
34/EU. See the UKEX and EU Declaration of Conformity at rok.auto/certifications for details.
• Provides protection type II 3 G Ex ec IIC T4 Gc according to EN 60079-7.
• Comply to Standards: EN IEC 60079-0:2018, EN IEC 60079-7:2015+A1:2018 reference certificate number DEMKO12ATEX1116807X and
UL22UKEX2516X.
• Are intended for use in areas in which explosive atmospheres caused by gases, vapors, mists, or air are unlikely to occur, or are likely
to occur only infrequently and for short periods. Such locations correspond to Zone 2 classification according to UKEX regulation 2016
No. 1107 and ATEX directive 2014/34/EU.

IEC Hazardous Location Approval


The following applies to products with IECEx certification. Such modules:
• Are intended for use in areas in which explosive atmospheres caused by gases, vapors, mists, or air are unlikely to occur, or are likely
to occur only infrequently and for short periods. Such locations correspond to Zone 2 classification to IEC 60079-0.
• Provide protection type II 3 G Ex ec IIC T4 Gc according to IEC 60079-7.
• Comply to Standards: IEC 60079-0:7th edition, IEC 60079-7:5.1 Edition, reference IECEx certificate number IECEx UL 21.0112X.

Special Considerations for Safe Use


WARNING:
• The equipment shall be mounted in an UKEX/ATEX/IECEX Zone 2 certified enclosure with a minimum ingress protection
rating of at least IP54 (in accordance with EN 60079-0) and used in an environment of not more than Pollution Degree 2 (as
defined in EN 60664-1). The enclosure must be accessible only by the use of a tool.
• This equipment must be used within its specified ratings that are defined by Rockwell Automation.
• Provisions shall be made to prevent the rated voltage from being exceeded by transient disturbances of more than 140% of
the peak rated voltage when applied in Zone 2 environments.
• Secure any external connections that mate to this equipment by using screws, sliding latches, threaded connectors, or other
means provided with this product.
• Do not disconnect equipment unless power has been removed or the area is known to be nonhazardous.
• Enclosure must be marked with the following: “Warning - Do not open when energized.” After installation of equipment into
the enclosure, access to termination compartments must be dimensioned so that conductors can be readily connected.
• The instructions in the user manual shall be observed.
• This equipment must be used only with UKEX/ATEX/IECEX certified Rockwell Automation backplanes.
• Earthing is accomplished through mounting of modules on rail.
• This equipment isn’t resistant to sunlight or other sources of UV radiation.

Prevent Electrostatic Discharge


ATTENTION:
• This equipment is sensitive to electrostatic discharge, which can cause internal damage and affect normal operation. Follow
these guidelines when you handle this equipment:
• Touch a grounded object to discharge potential static.
• Wear an approved grounding wriststrap.
• Do not touch connectors or pins on component boards.
• Do not touch circuit components inside the equipment.
• Use a static-safe workstation, if available.
• Store the equipment in appropriate static-safe packaging when not in use.

40 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

Before You Begin Consider these details before installing a CompactLogix™ 5370 L2 controller:
• The control system includes a controller, an embedded power supply, embedded I/O
points, and a 1769-ECR/1769-ECRK right end cap.
• The embedded power supply is a 24V DC input, isolated power supply
This graphic shows an example CompactLogix 5370 L2 controller.
1769-L24ER-QBFC1B Control System
End Cap

Embedded I/O Modules

Embedded Power
Supply Terminals

ATTENTION: You must use an external power supply that is Class 2 or SELV-
listed for series A L1 controllers.

For example, you can use a 1606-XLSDNET4, standard switched-mode power supply, as
shown in this chapter.
• The controllers have embedded I/O points. You wire the input and output points via a
removable connector.
• The controller supports the use of up to four Compact I/O™ modules on the local 1769
CompactBus backplane as local expansion modules.
For more information on how to use embedded I/O points and local expansion modules,
see Chapter 8, page 145.
• You must terminate the end of the CompactBus via a 1769-ECR/1769-ECRK right end cap
as shown in step 6 on page 50.
• You can’t remove nor install Compact I/O modules while the controller is powered.

ATTENTION: CompactLogix 5370 L2 control systems do not support removal


and insertion under power (RIUP). Removing a 1769 Compact I/O module or end
cap generates a controller fault and may also result in damage to system
components.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 41


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller Parts


These parts are included in the box when you order your controller:
• Controller - Specific catalog number varies by order
• 1769-ECR/1769-ECRK Compact I/O end cap/terminator
• 1784-SD1 Secure Digital (SD) card with 1 GB of memory storage
A 1784-SD2 SD card with 2 GB of memory storage, or more1784-SD1 SD cards, are also
available if you need extra memory.

IMPORTANT The life expectancy of nonvolatile media is dependent on the


number of write cycles that are performed. Nonvolatile media
use a wear leveling technique or technology for prolonging the
service life, but avoid frequent writes.
Avoid frequent writes when logging data. We recommend that
you log data to a buffer in the memory of your controller and
limit the number of times data is written to removable media.

42 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

Install the Secure The CompactLogix 5370 L2 controller is shipped from the factory with the 1784-SD1 SD card
installed.
Digital Card
Complete these steps to reinstall an SD card that has been removed from the controller back
into the controller or to install a new SD card into the controller.

We recommend that you leave the SD card in the controller, even when it isn’t used. If the
controller experiences a Major Non-recoverable Fault, extended fault information is saved to
the card.

WARNING: When you insert or remove the SD card while power is on, an electric
arc can occur. This could cause an explosion in hazardous location installations.
Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous
before proceeding.
1. Verify that the SD card is locked or unlocked according to your preference.
Consider that, if the card is unlocked, the controller can write data to it or read data
from it.

Unlocked Locked

2. Open the door for the SD card.

L24ER
QBFC1B

3. Insert the SD card into the SD card slot.


You can install the SD card in one orientation only. The beveled corner is at the bottom.
If you feel resistance when inserting the SD card, pull it out and change the orientation.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 43


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

4. Gently press the card until it clicks into place.

L24ER
QBFC1B

5. Close the SD card door.

L24ER
QBFC1B

We recommend that you keep the SD card door closed during normal system operation.
For more information on how to use the SD card, see Chapter 12, page 241.

44 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

Install the System Complete these tasks to install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system.

Mount the System


CompactLogix 5370 L2 control systems are mounted on a DIN rail. Install the DIN rail before
completing the steps that are required to install the system.

WARNING: When used in a Class I, Division 2, hazardous location, this equipment


must be mounted in a suitable enclosure with proper wiring method that
complies with the governing electrical codes.

Available DIN Rails

You can mount the CompactLogix 5370 L2 controller on these DIN rails:
• EN 50 022 - 35 x 7.5 mm (1.38 x 0.30 in.)
• EN 50 022 - 35 x 15 mm (1.38 x 0.59 in.)

ATTENTION: This product is grounded through the DIN rail to chassis ground.
Use zinc-plated chromate-passivated steel DIN rail to assure proper
grounding. The use of other DIN rail materials (for example, aluminum or
plastic) that can corrode, oxidize, or are poor conductors, can result in
improper or intermittent grounding. Secure DIN rail to mounting surface
approximately every 200 mm (7.8 in.) and use end-anchors appropriately. Be
sure to ground the DIN rail properly. Refer to Industrial Automation Wiring and
Grounding Guidelines, Rockwell Automation publication 1770-4.1, for more
information.

Minimum Spacing

Maintain spacing from enclosure walls, wireways, and adjacent equipment. Allow 50 mm (2 in.)
of space on all sides, as shown. This spacing provides ventilation and electrical isolation.

50 mm
Top (2 in.)

50 mm 50 mm
(2 in.)
CompactLogix 5370 L2

Supply and I/O Points

(2 in.)
Embedded Power

Compact I/O Module

Compact I/O Module

Compact I/O Module

Compact I/O Module


Controller with

End Cap

Side Side

Bottom 50 mm
(2 in.)

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 45


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

System Dimensions
1769-L24ER-QB1B Controller System Dimensions
27.65 mm
3.06 mm 59.70 mm
(1.09 in.)
(0.12 in.) (2.35 in.)
105 mm
(4.13 in.)

118.00 mm
(4.65 in.)

2.8 mm 115.00 mm
(0.12 in.) (4.53 in.)

1769-L24ER-QB1B Controller System Dimensions with Expansion Modules Installed

35.00 mm 18.00 mm
25.00 mm
(1.38 in.) (0.71 in.)
(0.98 in.)
105 mm 115.00 mm
(4.13 in.) (4.53 in.)

118.00 mm 126.6 mm
(4.65 in.) (4.98 in.)

46 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

1769-L24ER-QBFC1B Controller System Dimensions

3.06 mm 84.70 mm 27.65 mm


(0.12 in.) (3.33 in.) (1.09 in.)
105 mm
(4.13 in.)

118.00 mm
(4.65 in.)

2.8 mm 140.00 mm
(0.12 in.) (5.51 in.)

1769-L24ER-QBFC1B Controller System Dimensions with Expansion Modules Installed


35.00 mm
(1.38 in.) 25.00 mm
140.00 mm (0.98 in.)
105 mm
(5.51 in.)
(4.13 in.)

126.6 mm
118.00 mm (4.98 in.)
(4.65 in.)

18.00 mm
(0.71 in.)

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 47


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Controller System Dimensions

3.06 mm 27.65 mm
84.70 mm
(0.12 in.) (1.09 in.)
(3.33 in.)
105 mm
(4.13 in.)

118.00 mm
(4.65 in.)

2.8 mm 140.00 mm
(0.12 in.) (5.51 in.)

1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Controller System Dimensions with Expansion Modules Installed


35.00 mm
(1.38 in.) 25.00 mm
(0.98 in.)
140.00 mm
105 mm
(5.51 in.)
(4.13 in.)

118.00 mm 126.6 mm
(4.65 in.) (4.98 in.)

18.00 mm
(0.71 in.)

48 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

Ground the System

ATTENTION: This product is intended to be mounted to a well-grounded


mounting surface such as a metal panel. Additional grounding connections
from the power supply's mounting tabs or DIN rail (if used) aren’t required
unless the mounting surface can’t be grounded.
See Industrial Automation Wiring and Grounding Guidelines, Rockwell
Automation® publication 1770-4.1, for additional information.

Install the Controller


Complete these steps to install the controller.
1. Pull out the bottom locking tabs.

2. Hook the top of the controller on the DIN rail.


3. Swing it downward until the controller is flush against the DIN rail and push it down
against the DIN rail.
4. Push the controller against the DIN rail.
5. Push the locking tabs in.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 49


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

6. If you aren’t using local expansion modules, slide the 1769-ECR/1769-ECRK end cap onto
the right side of the controller.

IMPORTANT You must install an end cap onto the right side of the
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controller system either at the end of the
controller. You must also install an end cap at the end of any
local expansion modules that can be installed onto the controller.

7. Secure the end cap onto the controller by pushing the locking mechanism to the left.

If you’re using local expansion modules, see Chapter 8, page 172 for more information
on how to install them in a CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system.

50 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

Remove and Replace the Removable Terminal Block


To remove the RTB, loosen the upper and lower retaining screws. The terminal block backs
away from the module as you remove the screws. When replacing the terminal block, torque
the retaining screws to 0.46 N•m (4.1 lb•in).

3 1

Item Description
1 Wiring the fingersafe cover
2 Lower retaining screws
3 Upper retaining screws

Wire the Terminal Block


When wiring the terminal block, keep the fingersafe cover in place.
1. Loosen the retaining screws to be wired.
2. Route the wire under the terminal pressure plate.
You can use the bare wire or a spade lug. The terminals accept a 6.35 mm (0.25 in.)
spade lug.
The retaining screws are non-captive. You can use a ring lug [maximum
6.35 mm (0.25 in.) o.d. with a 3.53 mm (0.139 in.) minimum i.d. (M3.5)] with
the module.
3. Tighten the retaining screw and make sure that the pressure plate secures the wire.
Recommended torque when you tighten the retaining screws is
0.68 N•m (6 lb•in).
If you must remove the fingersafe cover, insert a screwdriver into one of
the square wiring holes and gently pry the cover off. If you wire the terminal
block with the fingersafe cover removed, you can’t put it back on the
terminal block because of wires in the way.

Wire Size and Terminal Screw Torque


Each terminal accepts one or two wires with these restrictions:
Wire Type Wire Size Terminal Screw Torque Retaining Screw Torque
Solid Cu-90 °C (194 °F) #14…#22 AWG 0.68 N•m (6 lb•in) 0.46 N•m (4.1 lb•in)
Stranded Cu-90 °C (194 °F) #16…#22 AWG 0.68 N•m (6 lb•in) 0.46 N•m (4.1 lb•in)

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 51


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

Connect Power to the Control System


You must connect an external Class 2 or SELV-listed power supply to the embedded power
supply of the controller. The external power supply converts 115/230V AC power to 24V DC
power.

WARNING: Do not connect directly to line voltage. Line voltage must be supplied
by a suitable, approved isolating transformer or power supply having short
circuit capacity not exceeding 100VA maximum or equivalent.

Consider these points before completing the steps in this section:


• This section describes how to connect power only to the embedded power supply of the
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controller.
For information on how to wire the embedded I/O module available on CompactLogix
5370 L2 controllers, see Chapter 8, page 145.
• Not all Class 2 or SELV-listed power supplies are certified for use in all applications, for
example, use in nonhazardous and hazardous environments.
Before installing an external power supply, consult all specification and certification
information to verify that you’re using an acceptable external power supply.
• This section describes how to wire terminals +24V DC and COM on the CompactLogix
5370 L2 controller. They’re the only terminals you wire to power the CompactLogix 5370
L2 control system.
Use only the FG terminal when connecting a field device to the controller.

For example purposes, this section uses a 1606-XLDNET4, standard switched-mode power
supply.

IMPORTANT The 1606-XLDNET4 power supply isn’t certified for use in all
applications, for example, you can’t use it in hazardous locations.

Complete these steps to connect power to the CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system.
1. Verify that the external 24V DC power source isn’t powered.
2. Mount the external 24V DC power source on a DIN rail.
The external 24V DC power source can be installed on the same DIN rail as the controller
or a separate DIN rail.
3. Connect the wires to the 24V DC+ and 24V DC- connections on the external 24V DC
power source.

WARNING: If you connect or disconnect wiring while the field-side power is on,
an electric arc can occur. This could cause an explosion in hazardous location
installations. Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous before
proceeding.

4. Strip 8 mm (0.31 in.) insulation from the end of the wire that you connect to the +24V DC
terminal on the controller.

52 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

5. Connect the wire from the 24V DC+ terminal on the external 24V DC power source to the
+24V DC terminal on the controller.

6. Strip 8 mm (0.31 in.) insulation from the end of the wire that you connect to the COM
terminal on the controller.
7. Connect the wire from the 24V DC- terminal on the external 24V DC power source to the
COM terminal on the controller.

IMPORTANT If your application requires a power control device, for example,


a switch or relay, between the external power supply and the
embedded power supply of the CompactLogix 5370 L2 controller
to control when the controller is powered, you must install the
power control device at the +24V DC terminal on the controller.
If you install the power control device at the COM terminal, the
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controller can’t power up or power down
properly.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 53


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

This graphic shows an external 24V DC power source that is connected to a CompactLogix
5370 L2 controller.

IMPORTANT When you remove power from the CompactLogix 5370 L2 controller to
cycle power, the OK status indicator of the controller remains lit briefly
as the controller passes through its shutdown sequence.
Do not reapply power from the external power supply to the embedded
power supply of the CompactLogix 5370 L2 controller until after the OK
status indicator of the controller is off.

CompactLogix 5370 Controllers have an embedded, battery-less Energy Storage


Module (ESM) that provides power to the CPU upon power-down, allowing the
controller to write customer application and tag data to the onboard nonvolatile
memory. In some cases, the ESM continues to provide enough power to keep the
wall clock active until its residual stored energy is depleted.

54 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

Connect to the Controller The controller has a USB port that uses a Type B receptacle. The port is USB 2.0-compatible
and operates at 12 Mbps.
Via a USB Cable
Use a USB cable to connect your computer to the USB port. With this connection, you can
update firmware and download programs to the controller directly from your computer.

ATTENTION: The USB port is intended only for temporary local programming
purposes and not intended for permanent connection.
The USB cable isn’t to exceed 3.0 m (9.84 ft) and must not contain hubs.

WARNING: Do not use the USB port in hazardous locations.

Plug the USB cable into the CompactLogix 5370 L2 controller.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 55


Chapter 3 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

Connect the Controller to an


EtherNet/IP Network WARNING: If you connect or disconnect the communication cable with power
that is applied to this module or any device on the network, an electric arc can
occur. This could cause an explosion in hazardous location installations.
Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous before
proceeding.

Connect the RJ45 connector of the Ethernet cable to one of the Ethernet ports on the
controller. The ports are on the bottom of the controller.

ATTENTION: Do not plug a DH-485 network cable or a NAP cable into the
Ethernet port. Undesirable behavior and/or damage to the port can result.

Bottom of Controller

Port 1 - Front

Port 2 - Back

IMPORTANT This example shows how to connect the controller to the network
through one port. Depending on the network topology of your
application, you can connect both ports of the controller to the
EtherNet/IP™ network.

Connecting to Different EtherNet/IP Network Topologies


CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers have embedded switch technology and two EtherNet/IP
ports that let you use it in various EtherNet/IP network topologies:
• Device Level Ring network topology - Both ports on the controller are connected to the
network.
• Linear network topology - Both ports on the controller are connected to the network.
• Star network topology - One port on the controller is connected to the network.

There are connection and configuration requirements for each EtherNet/IP network topology.

For more information about EtherNet/IP Network Topologies, see Chapter 6, page 104.

56 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 4

Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

Environment and Enclosure


ATTENTION: This equipment is intended for use in a Pollution Degree 2 industrial environment, in overvoltage Category II
applications (as defined in EN/IEC 60664-1), at altitudes up to 2000 m (6562 ft) without derating.
This equipment isn’t intended for use in residential environments and may not provide adequate protection to radio
communication services in such environments.
This equipment is supplied as open-type equipment. It must be mounted within an enclosure that is suitably designed for
those specific environmental conditions that will be present and appropriately designed to prevent personal injury resulting
from accessibility to live parts. The enclosure must have suitable flame-retardant properties to prevent or minimize the
spread of flame, complying with a flame spread rating of 5VA or be approved for application if nonmetallic. The interior of
the enclosure must be accessible only by the use of a tool. Subsequent sections of this publication may contain additional
information regarding specific enclosure-type ratings that are required to comply with certain product safety certifications.
In addition to this publication, see the following:
• Industrial Automation Wiring and Grounding Guidelines, publication 1770-4.1 for more installation requirements.
• NEMA 250 and EN IEC 60529, as applicable, for explanations of the degrees of protection provided by enclosure.

North American Hazardous Location Approval


The following information applies when operating this Informations sur l’utilisation de cet équipement en
equipment in hazardous locations. environnements dangereux.
Products marked "CL I, DIV 2, GP A, B, C, D" are suitable for use in Les produits marqués "CL I, DIV 2, GP A, B, C, D" ne conviennent
qu'à une utilisation en environnements de Classe I Division 2
Class I Division 2 Groups A, B, C, D, Hazardous Locations and Groupes A, B, C, D dangereux et non dangereux. Chaque produit
nonhazardous locations only. Each product is supplied with
markings on the rating nameplate indicating the hazardous est livré avec des marquages sur sa plaque d'identification qui
indiquent le code de température pour les environnements
location temperature code. When combining products within a dangereux. Lorsque plusieurs produits sont combinés dans un
system, the most adverse temperature code (lowest "T"
number) may be used to help determine the overall temperature système, le code de température le plus défavorable (code de
température le plus faible) peut être utilisé pour déterminer le
code of the system. Combinations of equipment in your system code de température global du système. Les combinaisons
are subject to investigation by the local Authority Having
Jurisdiction at the time of installation. d'équipements dans le système sont sujettes à inspection par
les autorités locales qualifiées au moment de l'installation.
WARNING: EXPLOSION HAZARD - WARNING: RISQUE D’EXPLOSION -
• Do not disconnect equipment unless power has • Couper le courant ou s'assurer que
been removed or the area is known to be l'environnement est classé non dangereux avant
nonhazardous. de débrancher l'équipement.
• Do not disconnect connections to this equipment • Couper le courant ou s'assurer que
unless power has been removed or the area is l'environnement est classé non dangereux avant
known to be nonhazardous. Secure any external de débrancher les connecteurs. Fixer tous les
connections that mate to this equipment by connecteurs externes reliés à cet équipement à
using screws, sliding latches, threaded l'aide de vis, loquets coulissants, connecteurs
connectors, or other means provided with this filetés ou autres moyens fournis avec ce produit.
product. • La substitution de composants peut rendre cet
• Substitution of components may impair équipement inadapté à une utilisation en
suitability for Class I, Division 2. environnement de Classe I, Division 2.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 57


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

UK and European Hazardous Location Approval


The following applies to products marked II 3 G. Such products:
• Are Equipment Group II, Equipment Category 3, and comply with the Essential Health and Safety Requirements relating to the design
and construction of such equipment given in Schedule 1 of UKEX Regulation 2016 No. 1107 and Annex II to EU Directive 2014/34/EU. See
the UKEx and EU Declaration of Conformity at rok.auto/certifications for details.
• Provides protection type II 3 G Ex ec IIC T5 Gc according to EN 60079-7.
• Comply to Standards: EN IEC 60079-0:2018, EN IEC 60079-7:2015+A1:2018 reference certificate number UL 21 ATEX 2603X and
UL22UKEX2515X.
• Are intended for use in areas in which explosive atmospheres caused by gases, vapors, mists, or air are unlikely to occur, or are likely
to occur only infrequently and for short periods. Such locations correspond to Zone 2 classification according to UKEX regulation 2016
No. 1107 and ATEX directive 2014/34/EU.

Special Considerations for Safe Use


WARNING:
• The equipment shall be mounted in an UKEX/ATEX Zone 2 certified enclosure with a minimum ingress protection rating of at
least IP54 (in accordance with EN 60079-0) and used in an environment of not more than Pollution Degree 2 (as defined in EN
60664-1). The enclosure must be accessible only by the use of a tool.
• This equipment must be used within its specified ratings that are defined by Rockwell Automation.
• Provisions shall be made to prevent the rated voltage from being exceeded by transient disturbances of more than 140% of
the peak rated voltage when applied in Zone 2 environments.
• Secure any external connections that mate to this equipment by using screws, sliding latches, threaded connectors, or other
means provided with this product.
• Do not disconnect equipment unless power has been removed or the area is known to be nonhazardous.
• Enclosure must be marked with the following: “Warning - Do not open when energized.” After installation of equipment into
the enclosure, access to termination compartments must be dimensioned so that conductors can be readily connected.
• The instructions in the user manual shall be observed.
• This equipment must be used only with UKEX/ATEX certified Rockwell Automation backplanes.
• Earthing is accomplished through mounting of modules on rail.
• Devices shall be used in an environment of not more than Pollution Degree 2.
• This equipment isn’t resistant to sunlight or other sources of UV radiation.

Prevent Electrostatic Discharge


ATTENTION:
• This equipment is sensitive to electrostatic discharge, which can cause internal damage and affect normal operation. Follow
these guidelines when you handle this equipment:
• Touch a grounded object to discharge potential static.
• Wear an approved grounding wriststrap.
• Do not touch connectors or pins on component boards.
• Do not touch circuit components inside the equipment.
• Use a static-safe workstation, if available.
• Store the equipment in appropriate static-safe packaging when not in use.

58 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

Before You Begin Consider these details when planning your CompactLogix™ 5370 L3 control system:
• The controller is the leftmost device in the system.
• Only one controller can be used on a local 1769 CompactBus. The controller supports the
local bank and up to two more banks.
• The controller has a power supply distance rating of four. This rating means that the
controller must be within four slots of the power supply. You can install as many as
three modules between the power supply and the controller, as shown in this graphic.

1769-L33ERM Compact I/O™ Power Supply End Cap

• The controllers support this many local expansion modules across multiple I/O banks.
Number of Local Expansion Modules Supported Across Multiple I/O Banks
Cat. No. Local Expansion Modules Supported, Max
1769-L30ER
1769-L30ERK
1769-L30ERM 8
1769-L30ERMK
1769-L30ER-NSE
1769-L33ER
1769-L33ERK 16
1769-L33ERM
1769-L33ERMK
1769-L33ERMO —
1769-L36ERM 30
1769-L36ERMO —
1769-L37ERM, 1769-L37ERMK 31
1769-L37ERMO(1) —
1769-L38ERM, 1769-L38ERMK 31
1769-L38ERMO(1) —
(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

• Each I/O bank requires its own power supply.


• You must terminate the end of the last bank in a CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system.
You can terminate a bank at the left or right end of the bank dependent upon your
system design.
A 1769-ECx end cap is required to terminate the end of the last bank in the control
system.
For example, if a CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system uses one bank, you must use a
1769-ECR/1769-ECRK right end cap to terminate the right end of the bank.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 59


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

For graphics of CompactLogix 5370 L3 control systems that use one bank or multiple
banks, see page 66.

ATTENTION: The CompactLogix 5370 L3 control systems do not


support removal and insertion under power (RIUP). These events
occur while the CompactLogix system is under power:
• Any break in the connection between the power supply and the
controller, for example, removing the power supply, controller, or an I/
O module, can subject the logic circuitry to transient conditions above
the normal design thresholds and can result in damage to system
components or unexpected behavior.
• Removing an end cap or an I/O module faults the controller and can
also result in damage to system components.

CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller Parts


These parts are included in the box when you order your controller:
• Controller - Specific catalog number varies by order
• 1784-SD1 Secure Digital (SD) card with 1 GB of memory storage
A 1784-SD2 SD card with 2 GB of memory storage, or more 1784-SD1 SD cards, are also
available if you need more memory.

IMPORTANT The life expectancy of nonvolatile media is dependent on the


number of write cycles that are performed. Nonvolatile media
use a wear leveling technique or technology for prolonging the
service life, but avoid frequent writes.
Avoid frequent writes when logging data. We recommend that
you log data to a buffer in the memory of your controller and
limit the number of times data is written to removable media.

60 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

Install the Secure The CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers ship from the factory with the 1784-SD1 SD card
installed.
Digital Card
Complete these steps to reinstall an SD card that has been removed from the controller back
into the controller or to install a new SD card into the controller.

IMPORTANT For more information on how to access the SD card in a 1769-L33ERMO,


1769-L36ERMO, 1769-L37ERMO(1), or 1769-L38ERMO(1) controller, see the
Armor™ CompactLogix Controllers Installation Instructions, publication
1769-IN021.
(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

We recommend that you leave the SD card in the controller, even when it isn’t used. If the
controller experiences a Major Non-recoverable Fault, extended fault information is saved to
the card.

WARNING: When you insert or remove the Secure Digital (SD) Card while power is
on, an electric arc can occur. This could cause an explosion in hazardous
location installations.
Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous before
proceeding.
1. Verify that the SD card is locked or unlocked according to your preference. Consider the
following when deciding to lock the card before installation:
- If the card is unlocked, the controller can write data to it or read data from it.

Unlocked Locked

2. Open the door for the SD card.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 61


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

3. Insert the SD card into the SD card slot.


You can install the SD card in only one orientation. The beveled corner is at the top. An
orientation logo is printed on the card.
If you feel resistance when inserting the SD card, pull it out and change the orientation.
4. Gently press the card until it clicks into place.

5. Close the SD card door.

We recommend that you keep the SD card door closed during normal system operation. For
more information on how to use the SD card, see Chapter 12, page 241.

62 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

Install the System Complete these steps to install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system.

Assemble the System

IMPORTANT For more information on how to install a 1769-L33ERMO, 1769-L36ERMO,


1769-L37ERMO(1), or 1769-L38ERMO(1) controller, see the Armor
CompactLogix Controllers Installation Instructions, publication
1769-IN021.
(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

You can attach an adjacent Compact I/O module or 1769 Compact I/O power supply to a
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controller before or after mounting. For mounting instructions, see
page 66 or page 69.

ATTENTION: Do not remove or replace this module while power is applied.


Interruption of the backplane can result in unintentional operation or machine
motion.

WARNING: Remove power before removing or inserting this module. If you insert
or remove the module while backplane power is on, an electric arc can occur.
This could cause an explosion in hazardous location installations.
Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous before
proceeding.

Complete these steps to install the controller. This example describes how to attach a 1769
Compact I/O power supply to the controller.
1. Verify that line power is disconnected.
2. Make sure that the bus lever of the 1769 Compact I/O power supply is in the unlocked
position. The bus lever leans to the right in the unlocked position.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 63


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

3. Use the upper and lower tongue-and-groove slots to secure the controller and power
supply together.

Tongue-and-groove Slots

4. Move the power supply back along the tongue-and-groove slots until the bus
connectors align with each other.
5. Use your fingers or a small screwdriver to push the bus lever of the power supply back
slightly to clear the positioning tab.
6. Move the bus lever of the power supply fully to the left until it clicks, which makes sure
that it locks.

7. If your system does not use any local expansion modules, use the tongue-and-groove
slots that were previously described to attach a 1769-ECR Compact I/O end cap
terminator to the last module in the system.

IMPORTANT You must install an end cap onto the right side of the
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controller system either at the end of the
controller. You must also install an end cap at the end of any
local expansion modules that can be installed onto the controller.
8. Wire the 1769 Compact I/O power supply according to the directions in the Compact I/O
Expansion Power Supplies installation instructions, publication 1769-IN028.
If you’re using local expansion modules, see Chapter 9, page 189.

64 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

Remove and Replace the Removable Terminal Block


To remove the terminal block, loosen the upper and lower retaining screws. The terminal block
backs away from the module as you remove the screws. When replacing the terminal block,
torque the retaining screws to 0.46 N•m (4.1 lb•in).

3 1

2
.

Item Description
1 Wiring the fingersafe terminal block
2 Lower retaining screws
3 Upper retaining screws

Wire the Terminal Block


When wiring the terminal block, keep the fingersafe cover in place.
1. Loosen the terminal screws to be wired.
2. Route the wire under the terminal pressure plate.
You can use the bare wire or a spade lug. The terminals accept a 6.35 mm (0.25 in.)
spade lug.
The terminal screws are non-captive. You can use a ring lug [maximum 6.35
mm (0.25 in.) o.d. with a 3.53 mm (0.139 in.) minimum i.d. (M3.5)] with the
module.
3. Tighten the terminal screw and make sure that the pressure plate secures the wire.
Recommended torque when you tighten the terminal screws is
0.68 N•m (6 lb•in).
If you must remove the fingersafe cover, insert a screwdriver into one of
the square wiring holes and gently pry the cover off. If you wire the terminal
block with the fingersafe cover removed, you can’t put it back on the
terminal block because of wires in the way.

Wire Size and Terminal Screw Torque


Each terminal accepts one or two wires with the following restrictions.
Wire Type Wire Size Terminal Screw Torque Retaining Screw Torque
Solid Cu-90 °C (194 °F) #14…#22 AWG 0.68 N•m (6 lb•in) 0.46 N•m (4.1 lb•in)
Stranded Cu-90 °C (194 °F) #16…#22 AWG 0.68 N•m (6 lb•in) 0.46 N•m (4.1 lb•in)

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 65


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

Mount the System


You can mount a CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system on a DIN rail or on a panel.

ATTENTION: During panel or DIN rail mounting of all devices, be sure that all
debris (such as metal chips or wire strands) is kept from falling into the
controller. Debris that falls into the controller could cause damage while the
controller is energized.

A CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system must be mounted so that the modules are horizontal
to each other. If you separate modules into multiple banks, the banks can be vertical or
horizontal to each other.
Example CompactLogix 5370 L3 Control Systems with Local Expansion Modules Installed

Horizontal Orientation

Bank 1 1769-CRLx Cable Bank 2 1769-CRLx Cable Bank 3

Bank 1

1769-CRRx Cable
Vertical Orientation

Bank 2

Before you mount a CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system, consider these requirements.

Minimum Spacing

Maintain spacing from enclosure walls, wireways, and adjacent equipment. Allow 50 mm (2 in.)
of space on all sides, as shown. This spacing provides ventilation and electrical isolation.

66 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

Top 50 mm
(2 in.)

50 mm 50 mm

CompactLogix 5370 L3
(2 in.) (2 in.)

Power Supply

Compact I/O

Compact I/O

End Cap
Module
Side Side

Controller
Bottom 50 mm

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 67


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

System Dimensions

This graphic shows the system dimensions.


18 mm
(0.71 in.)

55 mm 70 mm 35 mm
(2.17 in.) (2.76 in.) (1.38 in.)

132 mm
(5.20 in.)
118 mm
(4.65 in.)

52.5 mm 35 mm 35 mm 35 mm 35 mm
(2.07 in.) (1.38 in.) (1.38 in.) (1.38 in.) (1.38 in.)

105 mm
(4.13 in.)

68 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

Power Supply Distance Rating

CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers and the Compact I/O modules have power supply distance
ratings. Power supply distance ratings determine how many slots in a bank that a device can
be from the power supply.

For example, a product with a power supply distance rating of four can only have up to three
slots between it and the power supply.
Device Power Supply Distance Rating
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controller 4
1769 Compact I/O DeviceNet® scanner
4…8, depending on module
For more information about the power supply distance rating
Compact I/O module for a Compact I/O module, see CompactLogix Selection
Guide, publication 1769-SG001

CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers must be the leftmost device in the control system, and the
system only enables up to three modules between the controller and the power supply. This
graphic shows an example configuration.

Bank 1 1769-CRLx Cable Bank 2

Ground the System

ATTENTION: This product is intended to be mounted to a well-grounded


mounting surface such as a metal panel. Additional grounding connections
from the power supply's mounting tabs or DIN rail (if used) aren’t required
unless the mounting surface can’t be grounded.
See Industrial Automation Wiring and Grounding Guidelines, Rockwell
Automation publication 1770-4.1, for additional information.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 69


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

Mount the Controller on a Panel

Use two M4 or #8 pan head screws to mount the controller. Mounting screws are required on
many modules. Use the assembled modules as a template to drill holes in the panel, as follows:

IMPORTANT Due to module mounting hole tolerance, it’s important to follow this
procedure.
1. On a clean work surface, assemble no more than three modules.
2. Use the assembled modules as a template and carefully mark the center of all module-
mounting holes on the panel.
3. Return the assembled modules to the clean work surface, including any previously
mounted modules.
4. Drill and tap the mounting holes for the recommended M4 or #8 screw.
5. Place the modules back on the panel and check for proper hole alignment.
The grounding plate, that is, where you install the mounting screws,
grounds the module when it’s panel-mounted.
6. Use the mounting screws to attach the modules to the panel.
If you’re mounting more modules, mount only the last one of this group and
put the others aside. This process reduces remounting time when you are
drilling and tapping the next group of modules.
7. Repeat steps 1… 6 for any remaining modules.

Mount the Controller on the DIN Rail

You can mount the controller on these DIN rails:


• EN 50 022 - 35 x 7.5 mm (1.38 x 0.30 in.)
• EN 50 022 - 35 x 15 mm (1.38 x 0.59 in.)

ATTENTION: This product is grounded through the DIN rail to chassis


ground. Use zinc-plated chromate-passivated steel DIN rail to assure
proper grounding. The use of other DIN rail materials (for example,
aluminum or plastic) that can corrode, oxidize, or you’re poor
conductors, can result in improper or intermittent grounding. Secure
DIN rail to a mounting surface approximately every 200 mm (7.8 in.) and
use end-anchors appropriately. Be sure to ground the DIN rail properly.
Refer to Industrial Automation Wiring and Grounding Guidelines,
Rockwell Automation publication 1770-4.1, for more information.
1. Before mounting the controller on a DIN rail, close the DIN rail latches of the controller.
2. Press the DIN rail mounting area of the controller against the DIN rail.
The latches momentarily open and lock into place.

Connect Power to the Control System


Connect power to the CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system that is based on the 1769 Compact
I/O power supply your application uses. For more information on how to connect power to your
CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system, see the Compact I/O Expansion Power Supplies
Installation Instructions, publication 1769-IN028.
CompactLogix 5370 Controllers have an embedded, battery-less Energy Storage
Module (ESM) that provides power to the CPU upon power-down, allowing the
controller to write customer application and tag data to the onboard nonvolatile
memory. In some cases, the ESM continues to provide enough power to keep the
wall clock active until its residual stored energy is depleted.

70 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

Connect to the Controller The controller has a USB port that uses a Type B receptacle. The port is USB 2.0-compatible
and operates at 12 Mbps.
Via a USB Cable
Use a USB cable to connect your computer to the USB port. With this connection, you can
update firmware and download programs to the controller directly from your computer.

ATTENTION: The USB port is intended only for temporary local programming
purposes and not intended for permanent connection.
The USB cable isn’t to exceed 3.0 m (9.84 ft) and must not contain hubs.

WARNING: Do not use the USB port in hazardous locations.

IMPORTANT For more information on how to connect a USB cable to a 1769-


L33ERMO, 1769-L36ERMO, 1769-L37ERMO(1), 1769-L38ERMO(1) controller,
see the Armor CompactLogix Controllers Installation Instructions,
publication 1769-IN021.
(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

Plug the USB cable into the CompactLogix 5370 L3 controller as shown.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 71


Chapter 4 Install the CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

Connect the Controller to an


EtherNet/IP Network WARNING: If you connect or disconnect the communication cable with power
that is applied to this module or any device on the network, an electric arc can
occur. This could cause an explosion in hazardous location installations.
Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous before
proceeding.

Connect the RJ45 connector of the Ethernet cable to one of the Ethernet ports on the
controller. The ports are on the bottom of the controller.

ATTENTION: Do not plug a DH-485 network cable or a NAP cable into the
Ethernet port. Undesirable behavior or damage to the port can result.

Bottom of Controller

Port 1 - Front

Port 2 - Rear

IMPORTANT This example shows how to connect the controller to the network
through one port. Depending on the Ethernet network topology of your
application, you can connect both ports of the controller to the
EtherNet/IP™ network.

Connecting to Different EtherNet/IP Network Topologies


The CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers have embedded switch technology and two EtherNet/IP
ports that let you use it in different EtherNet/IP network topologies:
• Device Level Ring network topology - Both ports on the controller are connected to the
network with requirements about how the connections are made.
• Linear network topology - Both ports on the controller are connected to the network
with requirements about how the connections are made.
• Star network topology - One port on the controller is connected to the network.

For more information, see Chapter 6, page 99.

72 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 5

Complete Software Tasks Required at


CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

To complete the tasks that are described in this chapter, you must have the software that is
described in the following table installed on your computer.
Software Required Version
2.59.00 or later
CompactLogix™ 5370 L2 controllers require RSLinx Classic software,
RSLinx® Classic version 2.59.01 or later.
The 1769-L19ER-BB1B controller requires RSLinx Classic software, version
3.74.00
20 - For CompactLogix 5370 controllers using firmware revision 20.
RSLogix 5000® RSLogix 5000 software does not support the 1769-L19ER-BB1B controller.
21 or later - For CompactLogix 5370 controllers using firmware revision 21
Studio 5000 Logix Designer® or later.
28 or later - For the 1769-L19ER-BB1B controller.
BOOTP-DHCP server Most current version is installed with RSLinx Classic software installation
Installed with the installation of one of the following:
• RSLogix 5000 software, version 20
ControlFLASH™ • Studio 5000® environment, version 21 or later
• Studio 5000 environment, version 28 or later for 1769-L19ER-BB1B
controllers

CompactLogix 5370 controllers require a network Internet Protocol (IP) address to operate on
an EtherNet/IP™ network.

The IP address uniquely identifies the controller. The IP address is in the form xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx
where each xxx is a number from 000… 254 with some exceptions for reserved values. These
numbers are examples of reserved values that you can’t use:
• 000.xxx.xxx.xxx
• 127.xxx.xxx.xxx
• 224 to 255.xxx.xxx.xxx

Some other values are reserved based on an application-by-application basis.


You can complete one of these tasks dependent on system conditions:
• Set the IP address for a controller that does not have one assigned.
• Change the IP address for a controller that has an IP address that is assigned to it.

IMPORTANT CompactLogix 5370 controllers have two EtherNet/IP ports to connect


to an EtherNet/IP network. The ports carry the same network traffic as
part of the embedded switch of the controller. However, the controller
uses only one IP address.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 73


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Set the IP Address of You must set the IP address of a CompactLogix 5370 controller when the controller powers up
for the first time, that is, when commissioning the controller for the first time. You aren’t
a Controller required to set an IP address each time the controller cycles power.

You can use these tools to set the IP address of a CompactLogix 5370 controller:
• Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP) server
• Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) server
• RSLinx Classic software
• Studio 5000 Logix Designer® application
• SD card

IMPORTANT Each tool has connection requirements to set the IP address of the
controller via that tool. For example, your computer must be connected
to the controller via a USB cable to set the initial IP address of the
controller with RSLinx Classic software or the application.
This figure describes how to set the IP address of your CompactLogix 5370 controller on a
power cycle during initial installation or after operation has begun.

Controller Power Cycle

Use the USB driver in Yes Computer


RSLinx Classic software connected to
or the application to set controller via
the address. USB?

Does the controller have


an IP address in
Connect the computer
No nonvolatile memory or is
to controller via USB.
No an SD card installed that
is configured to load a
project (with an IP
No address) to the controller
on a power cycle?

No
Is the controller Is the controller
DHCP-enabled? BOOTP- enabled?

Yes

Yes Yes

Use DHCP to set Use BOOTP server to


Controller has an IP address.
the IP address. set the IP address.

74 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Use the BOOTP Server to Set the IP Address of the Controller


Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP) is a protocol that enables the controller to communicate with a
BOOTP server. The server can be used to assign an IP address. You can use the BOOTP server
to set an IP address for your CompactLogix 5370 controller.

Consider these points when using the BOOTP server:


• The BOOTP server is installed automatically when you install RSLinx Classic software or
the Studio 5000 environment on your computer. The BOOTP server sets an IP address
and other Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) parameters.
• A CompactLogix 5370 controller ships from the factory without an IP address and
BOOTP-enabled.
• This section describes how to use a Rockwell Automation® BOOTP/DHCP server. If you
use another BOOTP/DHCP server, contact your network administrator to verify that
you’re using it correctly.
• To use the BOOTP server, your computer and the controller must be connected to the
same EtherNet/IP network.
• If the controller is BOOTP-disabled, you can’t use the BOOTP server to set the IP address.

There are two conditions in which the CompactLogix 5370 controllers use the BOOTP servers
to set the IP address of the controller:
• Initial powerup - Because the CompactLogix 5370 controller ships with BOOTP-
enabled, when it is first powered up, the controller sends a request for an IP address on
the EtherNet/IP network. You can use the BOOTP server to set the IP address, as
described later in this section.
• Powerup after controller operation has begun - When controller power is cycled
after operation has begun, the BOOTP/DHCP server sets the IP address if one of these
conditions exists:
- Controller is BOOTP-enabled - You set the IP address manually with the BOOTP
server.
- Controller is DHCP-enabled - The IP address is set automatically via the DHCP server.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 75


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Access the BOOTP/DHCP utility from one of these locations:


• Start>Programs>Rockwell Software>BOOTP-DHCP Server
If you haven’t installed the utility, you can download and install it from rok.auto/
certifications.
• Tools directory on the programming software installation CD

IMPORTANT Before you start the BOOTP/DHCP utility, make sure that you have the
hardware (MAC) address of the controller. The hardware address is on
the front of the controller and uses an address in a format similar to the
following: 00:00:BC:2E:69:F6

Example Locations of Controller Hardware Address

1769-L18ERM-BB1B Controller 1769-L24ER-QB1B Controller 1769-L33ER Controller

Complete these steps to set the IP address of the controller with the
BOOTP/DHCP server.

IMPORTANT To use the BOOTP server, your computer and the controller must be
connected to the same EtherNet/IP network.
1. Start the BOOTP/DHCP software.
2. From the Tools menu, select Network Settings.

76 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

3. Enter the Subnet Mask of the network.

The Gateway address, Primary or Secondary DNS address, and Domain Name fields are
optional.
4. Select OK.
The Request History panel appears with the hardware addresses of all devices that
issue BOOTP requests. This process can take some time to complete.
5. Select the appropriate module.

6. Select Add to Relation List.

The New Entry dialog box appears.


7. Enter an IP Address, Hostname, and Description for the controller.

8. Select OK.
9. To assign this configuration to the controller, wait for the controller to appear in the
Relation List panel and select it.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 77


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

10. Select Disable BOOTP/DHCP.

When power is cycled, the controller uses the assigned configuration and does not
issue a BOOTP request.

IMPORTANT If you do not select Disable BOOTP/DHCP on a power cycle, the


host controller clears the current IP configuration and begins
sending BOOTP requests again.

If you select Disable BOOTP/DHCP and it does not disable BOOTP/DHCP, use RSLinx Classic
software or the Studio 5000 environment to disable BOOTP/DHCP.

To disable BOOTP/DHCP from RSLinx Classic software, perform the following:


1. Make sure that a USB cable is connected to your computer and the controller.
2. Start RSLinx Classic software.
After several seconds, an RSWho dialog box appears.
3. If no RSWho dialog box appears, from the Communications pull-down menu, select
RSWho.

4. Navigate to the USB network.


5. Right-click on the controller and select Module Configuration.

78 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

6. Select the Port Configuration tab.


7. From the Network Configuration Type, select Static to disable
BOOTP/DHCP.

8. Select OK.

To disable BOOTP/DHCP from the Studio 5000 environment, perform the following:
1. Start the application.
2. Open the project.
3. Right-click on the controller and select Properties.

4. On the Controller Properties dialog box, select the Internet Protocol tab.
5. Select Manually configure IP settings.

6. Select OK.
7. When prompted to confirm the IP address setting, select Yes.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 79


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Using DHCP Software

Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) software automatically assigns IP addresses to


client stations logging on to a TCP/IP network. DHCP is based on BOOTP and maintains some
backward compatibility. The main difference is that BOOTP allows for manual configuration
(static), while DHCP allows for both static and dynamic allocation of network addresses and
configurations to newly attached modules.

Be cautious when using DHCP software to configure a module. A BOOTP client, such as the
EtherNet/IP communication modules, can start from a DHCP server only if the DHCP server is
written to handle BOOTP queries. This requirement is specific to the DHCP software package
used. Consult your system administrator to see if a DHCP package supports BOOTP commands
and manual IP allocation.

ATTENTION: The EtherNet/IP communication module must be assigned a


fixed network address. The IP address of this module must not be
dynamically provided.
Failure to observe this precaution may result in unintended machine motion
or loss of process control.

Use the DHCP Server to Set the IP Address of the Controller


Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) server automatically assigns IP addresses to
client stations logging on to a TCP/IP network. DHCP is based on BOOTP and maintains some
backward compatibility. The main difference is that BOOTP manual configuration (static),
while DHCP enables static and dynamic allocation of network addresses and configurations to
newly attached controllers.

Be cautious when using the DHCP server to configure a controller. A BOOTP client, such as the
CompactLogix 5370 controllers, can start from a DHCP server only if the DHCP server is written
to handle BOOTP queries. This requirement is specific to the DHCP server used. Consult your
system administrator to see if a DHCP server supports BOOTP commands and manual IP
allocation.

ATTENTION: Assign the CompactLogix 5370 controllers a fixed network


address. The IP address of this controller isn’t to be dynamically provided.
Failure to observe this precaution can result in unintended machine motion or
loss of process control.

If you use the Rockwell Automation BOOTP or DHCP server in an uplinked subnet where a DHCP
server exists, a controller can procure an address from the enterprise server before the
Rockwell Automation utility even sees the controller. Disconnect from the uplink to set the
address and configure the controller to retain its static address before reconnecting to the
uplink, if necessary.

80 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Use RSLinx Classic Software to Set the Controller IP Address


You can use RSLinx Classic software to set the IP address of the CompactLogix 5370
controller.

IMPORTANT To set the IP address, that is, assign an IP address to a controller that
does not have one, for a CompactLogix 5370 controller via RSLinx
Classic software, you must be connected to your controller via the
USB port.
Complete these steps to set the IP address of the controller with RSLinx Classic software.

IMPORTANT These steps show a 1769-L36ERM controller. The same steps also apply
to all CompactLogix 5370 controllers with slight variations in screens.
1. Make sure that a USB cable is connected to your computer and the controller.
2. Start RSLinx Classic software.
After several seconds, an RSWho dialog box appears.
3. If no RSWho dialog box appears, from the Communications pull-down menu, select
RSWho.

The RSWho dialog box appears and includes the USB driver.
4. Right-click the EtherNet/IP module and select Module Configuration.

The Module Configuration dialog box appears.


5. Select the Port Configuration tab.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 81


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

6. For Network Configuration Type, select Static to assign this configuration to the port.

IMPORTANT If you select Dynamic, on a power cycle, the controller clears the
current IP configuration and starts to send BOOTP requests.
7. Enter the new IP address and Network Mask.
8. Select OK.

As with all configuration changes, if desired, make sure that you’re using the SD card in a way
that does not overwrite the IP address at the next controller power cycle.

For more information on how to use the SD card, see Chapter 12, page 241.

Use the Logix Designer Application to Set the IP Address of


the Controller
You can use Logix Designer application to set the IP address of a CompactLogix 5370
controller. To set the IP address via the application, you must be connected to your controller
via the USB port.

Complete these steps to set the IP address of the controller.

IMPORTANT These steps show a 1769-L18ERM-BB1B controller. The same steps also
apply to all CompactLogix 5370 controllers with slight variations
in screens.
1. Start the application.
2. Set the Project Path.
a. Select RSWho.

The RSWho dialog box appears.


b. Navigate over the USB network and select the CompactLogix 5370 controller.
c. Select Set Project Path.

82 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

3. Select Download.

4. Select Download again.

The new project is downloaded to the controller and the project goes online, in Remote
Program or Program mode.
5. Right-click the controller name and select Properties.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 83


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

6. On the Controller Properties dialog box, select the Internet Protocol tab.
The IP Settings Configuration values show that the controller has no IP address that is
assigned to it.

7. Select Manually configure IP settings.


8. Enter desired IP address and other configuration information and select OK.

9. When prompted to confirm the IP address setting, select Yes.

The controller now uses the newly set IP address.

84 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Use the SD Card to Set the IP Address of the Controller


You can use an SD card to set the IP address for a CompactLogix 5370 controller. If you use the
SD card to set the IP address, it eliminates the need for software to complete this task.

IMPORTANT To set the IP address from an SD card, software isn’t required during
the power-up process. However, you must have previously saved the
project to the SD card.
The IP address of the CompactLogix 5370 controller is automatically
configured at power-up as long as you’ve configured an IP address,
stored the program onto a controller, and set the SD card to the Load
Image parameter set to On Power Up.
The option to set the IP address of a CompactLogix 5370 controller via
an SD card at power-up is only one part of the process to load an entire
project to the controller from the SD card.
Use this option carefully. For example, the SD card can contain a
desirable IP address as part of an undesirable project, for example, a
project that is older than the project currently used on the controller.
These requirements apply when using the SD card to set the IP address on a CompactLogix
5370 controller:
• A project must be stored on the SD card.
• The project that is stored on the SD card is configured with the Load Image parameter
set to On Power Up.

For more information on how to use the SD card, see Chapter 12, page 241.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 85


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Change the IP Address of a You can change the IP address of a CompactLogix 5370 controller after system operation has
begun. In this case, the controller has an IP address that is assigned to it, but you must change
Controller that IP address.

You can use these tools to change the IP address of a controller:


• RSLinx Classic software
• Studio 5000 Logix Designer application
• SD card

IMPORTANT You can’t use any of these tools to change the IP address of a
controller:
• Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP) server
• Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) server
Consider these factors when you determine how to change the IP address of a controller:
• Network isolation from, or integration into, the plant/enterprise network
• Network size - For large, isolated networks, it can be more convenient and safer to use
a BOOTP/DHCP server rather than the Logix Designer application or RSLinx Classic
software. A BOOTP/DHCP server limits the possibility of duplicate IP address
assignment.
However, you can only use the BOOTP/DHCP server to set the IP address of the
controller and not to change it. If you decide to change the IP address of the controller
and want to use a BOOTP/DHCP server to limit the possibility of duplicate IP address
assignment, you must first clear the IP address.
After clearing the IP address, use the steps for using the BOOTP Server on page 75 or
the DHCP Server on page 80 to set the IP address of the controller.
• Company policies and procedures that deal with plant floor network installation and
maintenance
• Level of involvement by IT personnel in plant-floor network installation and
maintenance
• Type of training that is offered to control engineers and maintenance personnel

86 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Change the Network IP Address with RSLinx Classic Software

IMPORTANT The steps on page 81 describe how to use RSLinx Classic Software to
assign an IP address for a CompactLogix 5370 controller that does not
have an IP address.
The steps in this section describe how to use RSLinx Classic Software to
change the IP address on a CompactLogix 5370 controller that has an IP
address that is assigned to it.

The graphics in this section show how to change the IP address for a 1769-L36ERM controller.
The same steps also apply to all other CompactLogix 5370 controllers with slight variations in
screens.
1. Right-click the controller and select Module Configuration.

2. Select the Port Configuration tab when the Module Configuration dialog box appears.
The controller has an IP address and Network Configuration Type.
3. Enter a new IP address and make any other desired changes.
4. To assign this configuration to the controller, select Static in the Network Configuration
Type section of the dialog box.

IMPORTANT If you select Dynamic, on a power cycle, the controller clears the
current IP configuration and starts to send BOOTP or DHCP
requests, depending on the controller configuration.

5. Select OK.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 87


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Change the Network IP Address with Logix Designer Application

IMPORTANT The steps on page 82 describe how to use the Logix Designer
Application to assign an IP address for a CompactLogix 5370 controller
that does not have an IP address.
The steps in this section describe how to change the IP address on a
CompactLogix 5370 controller that has an IP address that is assigned
to it.

You can change the IP address of a CompactLogix 5370 controller via Logix Designer
application over a USB or EtherNet/IP network connection.

The graphics in this section show how to change the IP address for a 1769-L18ERM-BB1B
controller over a USB connection. The same steps also apply to all other CompactLogix 5370
controllers with slight variations in screens.
1. Verify that your computer is connected to the controller.
2. Verify that your project is online.
3. Right-click the controller name and select Properties.

You can also right-click the Ethernet node in the I/O Configuration section and
select Properties. The Controller Properties dialog box appears on the Internet Protocol
tab.
4. Change the IP address of the controller.
5. Make other changes where necessary.

6. Select OK.

88 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Change the Network IP Address with an SD Card


You can use an SD card to change the IP address for a CompactLogix 5370 controller when
controller power is cycled. If you use the SD card to change the IP address, it removes the need
for software to complete this task.

IMPORTANT To set the IP address from an SD card, software isn’t required during
the power-up process. However, you must have previously saved the
project to the SD card.
These requirements apply when using the SD card to change the IP address on a
CompactLogix 5370 controller:
• A project is stored on the SD card.
• The project that is stored on the SD card includes another IP address for the
CompactLogix 5370 controller than the IP address currently in use on the physical
controller that houses the SD card.
• The project that is stored on the SD card is configured with the Load Image parameter
set to On Power Up.
• Power is cycled to the controller with the SD card installed.

For more information on how to use the SD card, see Chapter 12, page 241.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 89


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Load the Controller You must download the current firmware before you can use the CompactLogix 5370
controller.
Firmware
IMPORTANT Do not interrupt a firmware update while it is in process. Firmware
update interruption can cause the firmware revision of the
CompactLogix 5370 controller to revert to its out-of-the-box revision
level, that is, 1.xxx.
To load the firmware, you can use any of the following:
• ControlFLASH software that installs with Logix Designer application
• AutoFlash that launches through the application when you download a project and the
controller does not have the matching firmware revision
• SD card (catalog numbers 1784-SD1 or 1784-SD2) with an image stored on the card

If you use the ControlFLASH or AutoFlash utilities, you need an


EtherNet/IP network or USB connection to the controller.

IMPORTANT The controller firmware revision that is loaded via the ControlFLASH
software or the AutoFlash option can be overwritten after future
controller power cycles if the conditions described on page 96 exist.

The firmware is available with the application or you can download it from the support website
at rok.auto/support.

Use the ControlFLASH Software to Load Firmware


You can use the ControlFLASH software to load firmware through a USB or EtherNet/IP network
connection. We recommend the following when you load the firmware via the ControlFLASH
software:
• Use a USB connection to load the firmware.
• Remove the SD card, if one is installed in the controller.

Complete these steps to use the ControlFLASH software to load the firmware.

IMPORTANT These steps show a 1769-L36ERM controller. The same steps also apply
to all other CompactLogix 5370 controllers with slight variations
in screens.
1. Verify that a connection exists between your computer and the CompactLogix 5370
controller.
2. Select Start>All Programs>FLASH Programming Tools>ControlFLASH.

90 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

3. When the Welcome dialog box appears, select Next.

4. Select the controller catalog number and select Next.

5. Expand the network until you see the controller.


6. Select the controller at the first instance in which it appears, as shown in the following
graphic, and select OK.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 91


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

IMPORTANT If you expand the controller, that is, expand the network beyond
the first instance in which it appears on the left side of the
screen, you receive the following message:
The target device isn’t in the proper mode to accept an update in
ControlFLASH.
7. Select the revision level to which you want to update the controller and select Next.

8. To start the update of the controller, select Finish and Yes.

92 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Before the firmware update begins, you see the following dialog box. Take the required
action for your application. In this example, the update continues when OK is selected.

After the controller is updated, the status dialog box displays the message Update
complete.

9. Select OK.
10. To close the ControlFLASH software, select Cancel and Yes.

Automatic Update for CompactLogix 5370 L1 Embedded I/O Module

IMPORTANT This section applies only to CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers.


After the controller firmware update process is complete, the controller can execute a
firmware update for its embedded I/O module.
Remember these points regarding the automatic firmware update for the embedded I/O
module:
• The firmware update occurs on only the embedded I/O module, not the local expansion
modules.
If you must update the firmware revision on any 1734 POINT I/O™ modules that are used
as local expansion modules, you must do so before installing them in the CompactLogix
5370 L1 control system.
• The firmware update on the embedded I/O module occurs automatically. No user action
is required.
• The update process can take a few minutes to complete.
• During the firmware update process, the OK status indicator on the controller remains
in a flashing red state.
• Do not cycle power to the controller while the firmware update for the embedded I/O
module is taking place.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 93


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Use AutoFlash to Load Firmware


You can use AutoFlash to load firmware through a USB or EtherNet/IP network connection.

Let the update complete without interruption. If you interrupt a firmware update that is in
process, you’re alerted that an error has occurred. In this case, cycle power to the controller.
The firmware revision level reverts to the 1.xxx revision level and you can begin the update
process again.

Complete these steps to use the AutoFlash utility to load the firmware.

IMPORTANT These steps show a 1769-L36ERM controller. The same steps also apply
to all CompactLogix 5370 controllers with slight variations in screens.
1. Make sure that the network connection is made and your network driver is configured
in RSLinx Classic software.
2. Create a controller project.
3. To specify the controller path, select RSWho.

4. Select your controller and select Download.

You can also select to select Update Firmware to complete this process. If you do so,
skip to step 6.
A dialog box appears to indicate that the project revision and controller firmware
revision are different.

94 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

5. Select Update Firmware.

6. Use the checkbox and pull-down menu to select your controller and firmware revision.
7. Select Update.

8. When the Update Firmware dialog box appears, select Yes.

Before the firmware update begins, you can be warned about your controller missing its
SD card. Take the required action, typically select OK, and the firmware update will
begin.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 95


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

9. When the firmware update is complete, the Download dialog box appears and you can
continue by downloading your project to the controller.

Use the Secure Digital Card to Load Firmware


You can use an installed SD card to load firmware on a CompactLogix 5370 controller. If you
use the SD card to load the firmware, it eliminates the need for software to complete this task.

IMPORTANT An installed SD card automatically updates the firmware of the


controller if the SD card is configured with the Load Image parameter
set to On Power Up. This feature is and can’t be disabled.

Your application requires the following to load the firmware from an SD card at power-up:
• You must have saved the project to the SD card before the power cycle.
• The firmware revision in the project that is stored on the SD card differs from the
firmware revision on the CompactLogix 5370 controller.

For more information on how to use the SD card, see Chapter 12, page 241.

96 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Select the Operating Mode CompactLogix 5370 controllers have slightly different front designs and mode switch
placements.
of the Controller
WARNING: When you change switch settings while power is on, an electric arc
can occur. This could cause an explosion in hazardous location installations.
Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous before
proceeding.
Mode Switch Placement on a CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controller

Mode Switch Placement on a CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller

Mode Switch Placement on a CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controller

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 97


Chapter 5 Complete Software Tasks Required at CompactLogix 5370 Controller Installation

Use the mode switch on the controller to set the operating mode of the CompactLogix 5370
controller.
Mode Switch Position Description
You can perform these tasks:
• Upload projects.
• Run the program and enable outputs.
You can’t perform these tasks:
• Update controller firmware.
Run • Create or delete tasks, programs, or routines.
• Create or delete tags or edit online.
• Import a program to the controller.
• Change the port configuration of the controller, advanced port configuration, nor network configuration settings.
• Change controller configuration parameters that are directly set for operation on a Device Level Ring (DLR) network topology.
You can perform these tasks:
• Update controller firmware.
• Disable outputs.
• Upload/download projects.
Prog
• Create, modify, and delete tasks, programs, or routines.
• Change the port configuration of the controller, advanced port configuration, nor network configuration settings.
You can’t perform these tasks:
• Use the controller to execute (scan) tasks.
You can perform these tasks:
• Upload/download projects.
• Change the port configuration of the controller, advanced port configuration, nor network configuration settings.
• Change between Remote Program, Remote Test, and Remote Run modes through the application.
• The controller executes (scans) tasks.
Remote Run • Enable outputs.
• Edit online.
Rem • Update controller firmware.
• Disable outputs.
• Create, modify, and delete tasks, programs, or routines.
Remote Program
• Download projects.
• Edit online.
• The controller does not execute (scan) tasks.
• Execute tasks with outputs disabled.
Remote Test
• Edit online.

98 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 6

Communicate Over Networks

All CompactLogix™ 5370 controllers support these tasks over an


EtherNet/IP™ network:
• Control distributed I/O
• Send/receive messages to/from other devices on the same network or another network
• Produce/consume (interlock) data between controllers
• Socket interface
CompactLogix 5370 L2 and L3 controllers support these tasks over a
DeviceNet® network:
• Control distributed I/O
• Send messages to devices on the same network; the controller can’t receive messages
from other devices on the network.

All CompactLogix 5370 controllers also support temporary connections from your computer
via a USB connection.

EtherNet/IP Network The EtherNet/IP network offers a full suite of control, configuration, and data collection
services by layering the Common Industrial Protocol (CIP™) over the standard Internet
Communication protocols, such as TCP/IP and UDP. This combination of well-accepted standards provides the
capability that is required to support information data exchange and control applications.

The CompactLogix 5370 controllers use socket interface transactions and conventional
communication over the EtherNet/IP network to communicate with Ethernet devices that do
not support the EtherNet/IP application protocol.

For more information on socket interface transactions, see page 108.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 99


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

Available Software
Use the software listed in this table with a CompactLogix 5370 controller on an EtherNet/IP
network.

Software Required Version Functions Required

Version 20 - For CompactLogix 5370 controllers that are • Configure the CompactLogix project.
RSLogix 5000 using firmware revision 20. • Define EtherNet/IP communication.
• Change IP address for devices on network,
Studio 5000 Logix Designer® Version 21 or later - For CompactLogix 5370 controllers including the CompactLogix 5370
application that are using firmware revision 21 or later. (1) controller. Yes. Studio 5000 Logix Designer
application, version 28 or later -
For 1769-L19ER-BB1B controllers
2.59.00 or later • Assign or change IP addresses to devices
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers require RSLinx on an EtherNet/IP network.
RSLinx® Classic Classic software, version 2.59.01 or later. • Configure communication devices.
The 1769-L19ER-BB1B controller requires RSLinx Classic • Provide diagnostics.
software, version 3.74.00. • Establish communication between devices.

Most current version is installed with Assign IP addresses to devices on an


BOOTP/DHCP utility No
RSLinx Classic software installation. EtherNet/IP network.
(1) If you’re using the L19 you must have at a minimum, Studio 5000®, version 28. There’s no version of RSLogix 5000 software, version 20, for support of the L19.

100 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

EtherNet/IP Network Functionality


The CompactLogix 5370 controllers offer this EtherNet/IP network functionality:
• Dual built-in EtherNet/IP network ports
• Support for the following EtherNet/IP network topologies:
- Device-level Ring Network topology
- Linear Network Topology
- Star Network Topology
• Support for CIP Sync™ technology
• Support for Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP network - Only the following
controllers support this functionality:
- 1769-L18ERM-BB1B
- 1769-L18ERM-BB1BK
- 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B
- 1769-L30ERM
- 1769-L30ERMK
- 1769-L33ERM
- 1769-L33ERMK
- 1769-L33ERMO
- 1769-L36ERM
- 1769-L36ERMO
- 1769-L37ERM
- 1769-L37ERMK
- 1769-L37ERMO(1)
- 1769-L38ERM
- 1769-L38ERMK
- 1769-L38ERMO(1)
• Socket interface to communicate with Ethernet devices that do not support the
EtherNet/IP application protocol
• Duplicate IP address detection
• Unicast and multicast communication
• Support messaging, produced/consumed tags, HMI, and distributed
I/O
• Interface via RJ45, twisted-pair cables
• Support half/full-duplex 10 Mbps or 100 Mbps operation
• Support standard switches
• No network scheduling required
• No routing tables required

(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 101


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

Nodes on an EtherNet/IP Network


When configuring your CompactLogix 5370 control system, you must account for the number
of Ethernet nodes you include in the I/O configuration section of your project. CompactLogix
5370 controllers have limits on the number of nodes that they support in the I/O configuration
section.
CompactLogix 5370 Controller Ethernet Node Guidelines
Cat. No. Ethernet Nodes Supported
1769-L16ER-BB1B 4
1769-L18ER-BB1B
1769-L18ERM-BB1B, 1769-L18ERM-BB1BK 8
1769-L19ER-BB1B, 1769-L19ER-BB1BK
1769-L24ER-QB1B
8
1769-L24ER-QBFC1B, 1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B
1769-L30ER, 1769-L30ERK
16
1769-L30ERM, 1769-L30ERMK
1769-L30ER-NSE
1769-L33ER, 1769-L33ERK
1769-L33ERM, 1769-L33ERMK 32
1769-L33ERMO
1769-L36ERM
48
1769-L36ERMO
1769-L37ERM, 1769-L37ERMK
64
1769-L37ERMO(1)
1769-L38ERM, 1769-L38ERMK
80
1769-L38ERMO(1)
(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

IMPORTANT While CompactLogix 5370 controllers offer the option of using Ethernet
node count to effectively design a control system, the controllers do
have connection limits on an EtherNet/IP network.
For more information on how to design EtherNet/IP network use in your
CompactLogix 5370 control system, see these resources:
• The EtherNet/IP Capacity Tool Wizard embedded in the Integrated
Architecture® Builder (IAB) software from Rockwell Automation: https://
www.rockwellautomation.com/en-us/support/product/product-
selection-configuration/integrated-architecture-builder.html
The EtherNet/IP Capacity Tool Wizard helps you in the initial layout of
your EtherNet/IP network.
• Ethernet Design Considerations Reference Manual, publication
ENET-RM002.

102 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

Devices Included in the Node Count

Any devices that you add directly to the local Ethernet I/O configuration are counted toward
the node limitation of the controller. The following are example devices that are added to the I/
O configuration section in your project and must be counted:
• Remote communication adapters
• I/O modules that are directly connected to the EtherNet/IP network, for example the
1732E-IB16M12R ArmorBlock® EtherNet/IP module
• Motion devices, such as drives
• Remote controllers
• HMI devices that are included in the I/O configuration section, for example, PanelView™
Plus terminals
• Linking devices, such as the 1788-EN2DNR, Ethernet-to-DeviceNet linking device or
1788-EN2DNROM, On-Machine™ Ethernet-to-DeviceNet linking device
• Third-party devices that are directly connected to the EtherNet/IP network

Devices Excluded from the Node Count

When considering the Ethernet node limitation of a CompactLogix 5370 controller, you do not
count Ethernet devices that exist on the EtherNet/IP network but aren’t added to the I/O
configuration section of the project.

The following devices aren’t added to the I/O configuration section in your project and aren’t
counted among the total number of nodes:
• Computer
• HMIs that aren’t added to the I/O configuration section, for example, PanelView™ Plus
terminals
• MSG instructions
• Devices the CompactLogix 5370 controllers use a socket interface to communicate
with.
For example, the following devices require communication via a socket interface:
- Modbus TCP/IP device
- Barcode scanners

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 103


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

EtherNet/IP Network Topologies


CompactLogix 5370 controllers support the EtherNet/IP network types that are detailed in this
section. Each of these EtherNet/IP network topologies supports applications that use
Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP network, if necessary.

Device-level Ring Network Topology

A DLR network topology is a single-fault tolerant ring network that is intended for the
interconnection of automation devices. A DLR network is composed of Supervisor (Active and
Backup) nodes and Ring nodes.

DLR network topologies automatically convert to linear network topologies when a fault is
detected. The conversion to the new network topology maintains communication of data on
the network. The fault condition is typically easily detected and corrected.

CompactLogix 5370 controllers connect directly to a DLR network topology, that is, without
requiring a 1783-ETAP tap to connect to the network. The controllers can function in any of the
roles on a DLR network topology, that is, active supervisor node, back-up supervisor node or
ring node.

IMPORTANT The topology graphics that are shown in this section are examples of
applications that use only DLR network topologies.
We recommend that you exercise caution if you consider designing an
application that includes the connection of a DLR topology with a linear
or star network topology.
For more information on using a DLR network topology, see the EtherNet/IP Embedded Switch
Technology Application Guide, publication ENET-AP005.
Example 1769-L18ERM-BB1B Control System Using DLR Network Topology
Stratix® 5700 1769-L18ERM-BB1B

Kinetix® 5500 PanelView Plus 7

1734-AENTR POINT I/O™ 1794-AENTR FLEX™ I/O

Kinetix 5500

104 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

Example 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Control System Using DLR Network Topology

• 1769-AENTR
Stratix 5700 • 1769 Compact I/O™ 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B

PowerFlex® 525
PanelView Plus 7

1734-AENTR POINT I/O 1794-AENTR FLEX I/O


Kinetix 5500

Example 1769-L33ERM Control System Using a DLR Network Topology

• 1769-AENTR
Stratix 5700 • 1769 Compact I/O 1769-L33ERM Control System

Kinetix 5500
PanelView Plus 7

Kinetix 5500
1734-AENTR POINT I/O 1794-AENTR FLEX I/O

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 105


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

Linear Network Topology

A linear network topology is a collection of devices that are daisy-chained together across an
EtherNet/IP network. Devices that can connect to a linear network topology use embedded
switch technology to remove any need for a separate switch, as required in Star network
topologies.
Example 1769-L18ERM-BB1B Control System Using a Linear Network Topology
1734-AENTR POINT I/O
1734-AENTR FLEX I/O

PanelView Plus

1769-L18ERM-BB1B
• Kinetix 350 • Kinetix 350
• 1783-ETAP • 1783-ETAP

Example 1769-L24ER-QB1B Control System Using a Linear Network Topology


1734-AENTR POINT I/O
1734-AENTR FLEX I/O

PanelView Plus

LINK 1 LINK 2

PORT 1 MOD NET


PORT 2

AUX POWER

1769-L24ER-QB1B 1732E-IB16M12R • Kinetix 350


• 1783-ETAP

Example 1769-L33ERM Control System Using a Linear Network Topology


• 1794-AENT FLEX I/O
1734-AENTR POINT I/O
• 1783-ETAP
002 1734-AENTR

POINT I O
Module
Status
Network
Activity
Network
Status
Point Bus
Link 1 Status
Activity/
Status System
Power
Field
Power
IP ADDRESS

Link 2
Activity/
Status

PanelView Plus

00:00:BC:2E:69:F6
1 (Front)
2 (Rear)

1769-L33ERM
• PowerFlex 525
• 1783-ETAP
Kinetix 5500

106 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

Star Network Topology

A star network topology is a traditional EtherNet/IP network that includes multiple devices that
are connected to each other via an Ethernet switch.
Example1769-L18ERM-BB1B Control System Using a Star Network Topology

1769-L18ERM-BB1B
IP Address:
ENET Address: 00:00:BC:66:0F:C7

Stratix 6000
LINK 1 LINK 2

PanelView Plus
1732E-IB16M12R 8 7
6 5

4 3
2 1

1734-AENTR POINT I/O


Kinetix 350

Example 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Control System Using a Star Network Topology

1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B

Stratix 6000 PanelView Plus


PowerFlex 525

Kinetix 350 1734-AENTR POINT I/O

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 107


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

Example 1769-L33ERM Control System Using a Star Network Topology

1769-L33ERM
00:00:BC:2E:69:F6
1 (Front)
2 (Rear)

Stratix 6000 PanelView Plus


Kinetix 6500 8 7
6 5

4 3
2 1

PowerFlex 525 1734-AENTR POINT I/O

Socket Interface with CompactLogix 5370 Controllers


CompactLogix 5370 controllers can use socket interfaces to communicate with Ethernet
devices that do not support the EtherNet/IP application protocol. The socket interface is
implemented via the Socket Object. CompactLogix 5370 controllers communicate with the
Socket Object via MSG instructions. To communicate with another device, you must
understand the application protocol of the other device.

CompactLogix 5370 controllers support up to 32 socket instances.

IMPORTANT Keep the following in mind when using sockets with CompactLogix 5370
controllers:
• A significant difference between CompactLogix 5370 controllers and
other Logix 5000™ controllers is the communication path.
CompactLogix 5370 controllers do not require a separate EtherNet/IP
network communication module, for example, a 1756-EN2T module. In
the case of the CompactLogix 5370 controllers, the MSG is sent to the
controller itself by using the path ‘1,0’.
• All CompactLogix 5370 controllers must use unconnected MSG
instructions for socket servers. When you configure a message for a
CompactLogix 5370 controller, make sure that the Connected checkbox
on the Message Configuration dialog box is cleared.
For more information on socket interface, see EtherNet/IP Socket Interface Application
Technique, publication ENET-AT002.

108 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

Quality of Service (QoS) and I/O Module Connections


CompactLogix 5370 controllers support Quality of Service (QoS) technology. QoS lets the
controller prioritize EtherNet/IP network traffic. By default, the CompactLogix 5370 controllers
are QoS-enabled. QoS can be disabled by configuring a message instruction in the Logix
Designer application.
Some EtherNet/IP devices do not support QoS technology unless the firmware of the device is
updated to a required minimum firmware revision level. For example, the ControlLogix® 1756-
ENBT communication module must use firmware revision 4.005 or later to support QoS
technology.

To make sure communication between CompactLogix 5370 controllers and


I/O modules are maintained, verify that the EtherNet/IP devices use the minimum firmware
revision level of the product that is required to support QoS technology.
For more information on the following, see Knowledgebase Technote, QoS Compatibility with
Embedded Switch Technology Products:
• Minimum firmware revision levels of EtherNet IP devices to support QoS technology
• Enable/disable QoS.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 109


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

EtherNet/IP Network Connections


CompactLogix 5370 controllers use connections to manage communication on the EtherNet/IP
network. A connection is a point-to-point communication mechanism that is used to transfer
data between a transmitter and a receiver. Connections can be logical or physical.

You indirectly determine the number of connections the controller uses by configuring the
controller to communicate with other devices in the system.

Connections are allocations of resources that provide more reliable communication between
devices than unconnected messages.

All EtherNet/IP connections are unscheduled. An unscheduled connection is a message


transfer between controllers that the requested packet interval (RPI) or the program, such as
an MSG instruction, triggers. Unscheduled messaging lets you send and receive data when
needed.
CompactLogix 5370 Controller EtherNet/IP Network Port Specifications

CIP Packet Rate Capacity


Connections SNMP Produced/Consumed Tags
Unconnected (packets/second)(1)
Support Media
Cat. No. Messages Number of
(password Support Unicast
Controller TCP CIP (backplane + I/O HMI/MSG Multicast
required)
Ethernet) (2) Available
Tags, Max
1769-L16ER-BB1B
1769-L18ER-BB1B
1769-L18ERM-BB1B
1769-L18ERM-BB1BK
1769-L19ER-BB1B
1769-L19ER-BB1BK
1769-L24ER-QB1B
1769-L24ER-QBFC1B
1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B
1769-L30ER
1769-L30ERK
1769-L30ERM 32 multicast
400 produced
1769-L30ERMK 6000 @ 500 messages/s
1769-L30ER-NSE 256 120 256 256 bytes/ @ 20% Yes Twisted Pair 128 tags Yes
unicast
packet comm.
1769-L33ER produced
timeslice tags
1769-L33ERK
1769-L33ERM
1769-L33ERMK
1769-L33ERMO
1769-L36ERM
1769-L36ERMO
1769-L37ERM
1769-L37ERMK
1769-L37ERMO(3)
1769-L38ERM
1769-L38ERMK
1769-L38ERMO(3)
(1) Total packet rate capacity = I/O Produced Tag, max + HMI/MSG, max Packet rates vary depending on packet size. For more detailed specifications, see the capacity section of the EDS file for
the catalog number.
(2) These are the maximum numbers of CIP I/O connections.
(3) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

110 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

DeviceNet Network The CompactLogix 5370 L2 and L3 controllers communicate with other devices over the
DeviceNet network via a Compact I/O 1769-SDN DeviceNet scanner. The DeviceNet network
Communication uses the Common Industrial Protocol (CIP) to provide the control, configuration, and data
collection capabilities for industrial devices.

IMPORTANT This section applies to applications using only CompactLogix 5370 L2


and L3 controllers. CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers do not operate on
DeviceNet networks.

Available Software
The software applications that are listed in this table are required when using a CompactLogix
5370 L2 or L3 controller on a DeviceNet network.
Software Required Version Functions
RSLogix 5000® 20 - For CompactLogix 5370 controllers using firmware revision 20.
21 or later - For CompactLogix 5370 controllers using firmware revision 21 or later. Configure the CompactLogix project
Studio 5000® environment Studio 5000 environment, version 28 or later - For 1769-L19ER-BB1B controllers.
• Configure communication devices
RSLinx Classic 2.59.00 or later(1), (2), (3) • Provide diagnostics
• Establish communication between devices
One of the following:
• Configure DeviceNet devices
RSNetWorx™ for DeviceNet • 11.00.00 or later if used with RSLogix 5000 software, version 20.xx.xx
• Define the scanlist for the DeviceNet network
• 21.00.00 or later if used with the Studio 5000 environment, version 21.00.00 or later
(1) CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers require RSLinx Classic software, version 2.59.01 or later.
(2) We recommend that you use RSLinx Classic software, version 3.51.00 or later, with the Studio 5000 environment, version 21.00.00 or later.
(3) RSLinx Classic software, version 3.74.00 is recommended for use with the 1769-L19ER-BB1B controller.

Example 1769-L24ER-QB1B Control System Using a DeviceNet Network

• 1769-L24ER-QB1B
DeviceNet Connection • 1769-SDN Scanner

1606-XLDNET E3™ Electronic • 1734-ADN POINT I/O


Overload Relay • POINT I/O

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 111


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

Example 1769-L33ERM Control System Using a DeviceNet Network

• 1769-L24ER-QB1B
DeviceNet Connection • 1769-SDN Scanner

1606-XLDNET E3 Electronic • 1734-ADN POINT I/O


Overload Relay • POINT I/O

Compact I/O 1769-SDN DeviceNet Scanner


You connect a CompactLogix 5370 L2 or L3 controller to a DeviceNet network via a Compact I/
O 1769-SDN DeviceNet scanner.

Before installing the scanner, consider these details:


• You can connect the scanner to an adjacent controller, power supply, or I/O module.
• You must account for these two requirements jointly:
- Power Supply Distance Rating, described on page 113
- Current Capacity in CompactLogix 5370 L3 Control Systems, described on page 116
• The scanner, as a master, can own up to 63 slave I/O nodes.
• Another DeviceNet master can own a scanner that is simultaneously a master and be a
slave.

The scanner has this functionality:


• Supports messaging to devices, not controller to controller
• Supports control-level network to device-level network for programming, configuration,
control, or data collection
• Supports back up your CompactLogix 5370 L2 or L3 controller on the DeviceNet network
For more information on using the 1769-SDN to back up your CompactLogix 5370 L2 or
L3 controller, see the 1769-SDN DeviceNet Scanner Module User Manual, publication
1769-UM009.
• Shares a common application layer with EtherNet/IP networks
• Offers diagnostics for improved data collection and fault detection

112 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

Power Supply Distance Rating


CompactLogix 5370 L2 and L3 control systems enable you to install 1769-SDN scanners as local
expansion modules. The 1769-SDN scanner has a power supply distance rating that you must
consider before installing it.

Power supply distance rating is the number of slots a 1769-SDN scanner can be installed away
from the power supply. The 1769-SDN scanner has a power supply distance rating of four.
Therefore, your CompactLogix 5370 L2 or L3 control system can include up to three modules
between the 1769-SDN scanner and the power supply.

The power supply distance rating of the 1769-SDN scanner as a design consideration differs by
CompactLogix L2 controller catalog number.

CompactLogix 5370 L2 Control Systems

In a CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system, you can install a 1769-SDN scanner on the right side
of the control system. The controller has an embedded power supply, which disallows the
installation of 1769-SDN scanners between the controller and the power supply.

Additionally, the controller has embedded I/O modules that disallow installation of the 1769-
SDN scanner directly to the right of the embedded power supply. CompactLogix 5370 L2
control systems have one or two embedded I/O modules, described as follows:
• 1769-L24ER-QB1B controller - One embedded I/O module
• 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B, 1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK, and 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers - Two
embedded I/O modules

While the embedded I/O modules aren’t considered local expansion modules, you must still
include each embedded I/O module in the module slot count when determining where to install
the 1769-SDN scanner as a local expansion module.

The farthest local expansion module slot where you can install the 1769-SDN scanner in a
CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system is module slot number two or three as determined by
the controller catalog number that is used in the control system.
This table lists the farthest local expansion module slot where you can install a 1769-SDN
scanner and meet its power supply distance rating requirement.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 113


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

Example CompactLogix 5370 L2 Control Systems with a 1769-SDN Scanner


Controller Cat. No. Number of Embedded I/O Modules 1769-SDN Scanner Power Supply Distance Rating Calculation Impact
The embedded I/O module is the first module in the module count. At its maximum power supply distance
rating, the 1769-SDN scanner can be installed in slot 3 of the local expansion modules, as shown in the
following graphic.

1769-L24ER-QB1B 1

Three modules between the power supply and the 1769-SDN scanner. With this controller catalog number, you can only
install up to two local expansion modules between the controller and the 1769-SDN scanner.
The embedded I/O modules are the first two modules in the module count. At its maximum power supply
distance rating, the 1769-SDN scanner can be installed in slot 2 of the local expansion modules, as shown in
the following graphic.

Three modules between the power supply and the 1769-SDN scanner. With this controller catalog number, you can only
install one local expansion module between the controller and the 1769-SDN scanner.

IMPORTANT When counting I/O modules to determine the 1769-SDN scanner


placement in a 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B, 1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK, or 1769-
L27ERM-QBFC1B control system, the embedded I/O module
1769-L24ER-QBFC1B appearance is different between the physical appearance and the
1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK 2 appearance in the application of the module.
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B
The physical appearance is shown in the previous graphic. The
second module is two rows of termination points below one set of
status indicators.
In the application, the second embedded I/O module appears as
two modules in the Controller Organizer each with their own slot
number, that is [2] and [3].
When the 1769-SDN scanner is installed in the farthest local
expansion module slot possible, that is the fourth module in the
control system, it appears with a [5] designation in the Controller
Organizer, as shown in the following graphic.

Modules [2] and [3] are


shown separately but
are considered one
module when counting
modules to meet power
supply distance rating
requirements.

114 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

CompactLogix 5370 L3 Control Systems

CompactLogix 5370 L3 control systems do not have embedded I/O modules. You begin
counting local expansion slots with the first Compact I/O module installed next to the power
supply when determining where to install a 1769-SDN scanner and meet its power supply
distance rating.
In CompactLogix 5370 L3 control systems, you can install 1769-SDN scanners to the left or right
side of the power supply. You can also use local and extra banks in CompactLogix 5370 L3
control systems, with each allowing the inclusion of a 1769-SDN scanner.

In the local bank, the controller must be the leftmost device in the system and you can only
install up to three modules between the controller and the power supply. Therefore, any 1769-
SDN scanners that are installed to the left of the power supply in the local bank, are in a
module slot that meets the power supply distance rating requirements of the module.
CompactLogix 5370 L3 control systems also support the use of extra banks for the local
expansion modules of the system. Each additional bank requires a 1769 Compact I/O power
supply. The bank can be designed with local expansion modules on either side of the power
supply.

In this case, you must install the 1769-SDN scanner with no more three Compact I/O modules
between the scanner and the power, regardless of whether the modules are installed to the
left or right of the power supply.

This graphic shows 1769-SDN scanners that are installed in a 1769-L36ERM control system that
meet the power supply distance rating of the module.

Local Bank

1769-SDN Scanner Installed in a 1769-L36ERM Control System Meeting the


Power Supply Distance Rating Requirements of the Scanner

Extra Bank

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 115


Chapter 6 Communicate Over Networks

Current Capacity in CompactLogix 5370 L3 Control Systems


In a local or extra bank, the modules that are installed on either side of the power supply can’t
draw more current than the power supply can supply. This requirement partially dictates
module placement on the bank.

For example, if a bank uses a 1769-PA2 Compact I/O power supply, each side of the bank has a
current capacity of 1 A at 5V DC and 0.4 A at 24V DC. Because a

1769-SDN scanner has a current draw of 440 mA at 5V DC and 0 mA at


24V DC, you can only install up to two scanners on each side of the power supply in the bank in
this case.
For more information on 1769 Compact I/O power supply maximum current capacity and
calculations you can use to design the modules that are used in local or extra banks, see
Chapter 9, page 194.

116 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7

Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370


L1 Controllers

Select I/O Modules This chapter details the I/O module options that CompactLogix™ 5370 L1 control systems offer.

Connect Field Power to I/O Devices


Chapter 2, page 32, describes how to connect power to an L1 series B or C controller. The
graphics in this section show how to connect a dedicated, Class 2/SELV-listed external 24V DC
power source to the VDC+ and VDC- terminals on the removable connector. Those connections
provide power to only the system-side of the embedded I/O and local expansion I/O modules.

IMPORTANT You must connect a separate external power source to the FP+ and FP-
terminals on the removable connector on the controller to power the
field-side circuitry of the embedded I/O modules and the local
expansion modules for only series A L1 controllers. See Appendix C,
page 257 for further information.

Power connections to the FP+ and FP- terminals provides power to input and output devices
that are connected to the embedded I/O modules or local expansion modules of the controller.
For example, input or output devices, such as a barcode scanner.

The embedded I/O of the controller and the field-side power of the local expansion modules is
24V DC nominally with an input range of
10…28.8V DC.

This graphic shows the removable connector.

IMPORTANT The controller is grounded once it’s installed on a DIN rail as described
in Chapter 2, page 28.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 117


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Consider these points before completing the steps in this section:


• This section describes how to connect a 24V DC power source to power input or output
devices that are connected to the embedded I/O or local expansion modules of the
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller via FP+ and FP- terminals.
For information on how to connect 24V DC power to the CompactLogix 5370 L1
controller and the POINTBus™ backplane via VDC+ and VDC- terminals on the removable
connector, see Chapter 2, page 32.
• The external 24V DC power source that is connected to the FP+ and FP- terminals must
be separate from the power source that is dedicated to power the controller via the
VDC+ and VDC- terminals for only series A controllers (see Appendix C, page 257).
• You can use the external 24V DC power source that provides power to the FP+ and FP-
terminals to power other components or devices in the application.
• The external 24V DC power source that provides power to the FP+ and FP- terminals can
be installed on the same DIN rail as the external 24V DC power source that provides
power to the VDC+ and VDC- terminals or you can install the external 24V DC power
sources on separate DIN rails.
• Use a power source that most effectively meets your application needs. That is,
calculate the power requirements of your application before choosing a power source
to avoid using a power source that far exceeds your application requirements:
- Limit field power current to 3 A or use a 1734-FPD module to avoid blowing the
internal fuse.
- Install a user-replaceable fuse with overcurrent protection of 4…6 A @ 52.5…68.25
I²t in line between the incoming power and the FP+ terminal.
• This section assumes that any DIN rail that you use has been grounded following
Industrial Automation Wiring and Grounding Guidelines, publication 1770-4.1.
• For example purposes, this section describes how to use a 1606-XLE80E, Class 2
switched-mode power supply with the FP+ and FP- terminals. The exact steps for other
external power supplies can vary from the steps that are described here.

IMPORTANT Do not use the following steps to connect power to the CompactLogix
5370 series A L16ER, L18ER, and L18 ERM controllers. Appendix C,
page 257 provides steps to connect power to the CompactLogix 5370
series A L16ER, L18ER, and L18 ERM controllers. The steps are also an
optional way to connect power to a series B or C L1 controller.

Complete these steps to connect power to CompactLogix 5370 series B and C L16ER, L18ER, or
L18ERM controllers, and series A and C L19 controllers.
1. Verify that the separate external 24V DC power source that powers the CompactLogix
5370 L1 controller isn’t powered.
2. Connect the wires to the + and - connections on the external 24V DC power source.

WARNING: If you connect or disconnect wiring while the field-side power is on,
an electric arc can occur. This could cause an explosion in hazardous location
installations. Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous before
proceeding.

118 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

3. Loosen the screws that secure the removable connector to the CompactLogix 5370 L1
controller and pull the connector off the controller.
Wires that are connected between external
24V DC power source and VDC+ and VDC-
terminals on the removable connector.

4. Connect the wire that is connected to the + terminal on the external 24V DC power
source to the FP+ terminal. The FP+ terminal is the fourth terminal from the top on the
removable connector.

5. Connect the wire that is connected to the - terminal on the external 24V DC power
source to the FP- terminal. The FP- terminal is the fifth terminal from the top on the
removable connector.

6. Plug the removable connector into the controller.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 119


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

7. Secure the removable connector in place.

8. Turn on power to the separate external 24V DC power source connected to the
removable connector.
The following graphic shows separate external 24V DC power supply that is connected to the
VDC+/VDC- and FP+/FP- terminals on the removable connector, respectively.

IMPORTANT No wires are connected to the NC terminal.

120 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Embedded I/O Modules


CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers provide an embedded power supply and an embedded I/O
module with these points:
• 16 sinking 24V DC digital input points
• 16 sourcing 24V DC digital output points

The following diagram shows the wiring terminals on the embedded I/O module.

Consider the following when you connect input or output devices to the embedded I/O modules
of your CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller:
• You must connect an external 24V DC power source to the FP+ and FP- terminals on the
removable connector on the controller to the power input and output devices that are
connected to the embedded I/O modules on the controller:
- Series A for L16ER, L18ER, and L18ERM controllers require an extra external 24V DC
power source for the FP+ and FP- terminal connections. For more information on
how to connect an extra external power source for a series A L1 controller to the FP+
and FP- terminals, see Appendix C, page 257.
- Series B and C controllers use the external 24V DC power source that is connected to
the VDC+ and VDC- terminals on the controller for the FP+ and FP- terminal
connections. Series B and C controllers can also use an extra external 24V DC power
source for the FP+ and FP- terminal connections. See Appendix C, page 257 for more
information on how to connect the extra external power source to the FP+ and FP-
terminals. For more information on how to connect the external power source to the
FP+ and FP- terminals on the series B and C controllers, see page 118.
The field-side power requirement of the embedded I/O modules of the controller is 24V
DC nominally with an input range of 10…28.8V DC.
• The available RPI range of the I/O points is 1.0 ms… 750.0 ms and can be changed by 0.5
ms increments. The default setting is 20 ms.

IMPORTANT • If you attempt to use an RPI value that is not valid, the application
automatically rounds the value down to the closest 0.5 ms
increment when you apply the change.
For example, if you set the RPI = 1.75 ms, when you select Apply
or OK, the value is rounded down to 1.5 ms and applied.
• The RPI value for embedded I/O module is intended to establish a
time interval at which data is transmitted. However, the
configuration of your CompactLogix 5370 L1 control system can
affect the actual time interval of data transmission.
For more information, see Estimate Requested Packet Interval
on page 132.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 121


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Complete these steps to wire the input and output points on the CompactLogix 5370 L1
controller.
1. Verify that the control system isn’t powered.
2. Use a small screwdriver to push the spring release clip and insert the wire.

3. With the wire in place, pull the screwdriver off the spring release clip.
4. Repeat step 2 for all embedded I/O wires that are needed in your application.

To remove a wire from the removable connector, complete these steps.


1. Verify that the control system isn’t powered.
2. Use a small screwdriver to push the spring release clip and pull out the wire.

Remove and Replace and I/O Module Connector

Complete these steps to remove and replace and I/O module connector.
1. Verify that the control system isn’t powered.
2. Use a small screwdriver to loosen the screws that secure the connector to the module.

3. Pull the connector out from the I/O module to remove it.
4. Disconnect any wires from the connector.
5. Connect any wires to the replacement connector.
6. Push the replacement connector back into the I/O module.
7. Secure the connector to the I/O module with the small screwdriver.

122 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Embedded Input Points

The embedded input points on the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers support 2-wire and 3-
wire input devices. You can wire the input devices to be powered in one of the following
methods:
• By using an external power supply, as shown in Figure 2 on page 124 - In this case, you
can monitor the input devices even if field power is interrupted, for example, by the
Master Control Relay (MCR).
This method is required if you must continue reading data from the input devices when
the embedded output terminals are disabled, for example, when the use of an MCR
disrupts output power.
• By using the V terminal on the embedded I/O module, as shown in Figure 4 on page 125
- In this case, you can’t monitor the input devices even if field power is interrupted, for
example, by the MCR.

Figure 2 on page 124 and Figure 3 on page 124 show examples of how to power 2-wire and 3-
wire input devices in your application.

IMPORTANT When using Figure 2 on page 124 and Figure 3 on page 124, use the
following guidelines:
• With this wiring configuration, you can monitor the input devices even if
field power is interrupted, for example, by the MCR. The FP- connection
must be maintained as a reference for inputs to function.
• With this wiring configuration, the controller does not help protect field-
side devices from overcurrent draw conditions.
• Design your application so that power consumption does not exceed the
power supply ratings.
• The following figure is a wiring example that complies with the National
Electrical Code (NEC) standard for isolation between system and field
power.
• The FP+ terminal on the removable connector is the voltage connection.
• The FP- terminal on the removable connector is the common
connection.
• The MCR must be closed for the removable connector to provide power
to the embedded I/O module.
• Install a user-replaceable fuse with overcurrent protection of
4…6 A @ 52.5…68.25 I²t in line between the incoming power and the FP+
terminal.
For series A L1 controllers only, you must use a separate, dedicated
Class 2 power supply for the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller and a
separate power supply for the embedded I/O module (see Appendix C,
Connect Field Power to Series A L1 Controllers for I/O Devices ).

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 123


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Figure 2 - CompactLogix 5370 L16ER, L18ER, and L18ERM Controllers with Input Devices Powered by
External Power Supplies (Series A [Alternate Series B and C])

Power
Supply 1

MCR

Power 2-wire Prox 3-wire Prox


Supply 2

Figure 3 - CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers with Input Devices Powered by External Power Supplies
(Series B and C)

MCR

Power 2-wire Prox 3-wire Prox


Supply

124 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Figure 4 on page 125 and Figure 5 on page 126 shows examples of how to power 2-wire and 3-
wire input devices in your application with connections to a V terminal.

IMPORTANT When using Figure 4 on page 125 and Figure 5 on page 126, use the
following guidelines:
• With this wiring configuration, the input devices lose power if the
removable connector does not power the embedded I/O modules.
• With this wiring configuration, the controller does not help protect field-
side devices from overcurrent draw conditions.
• Design your application so that power consumption does not exceed the
power supply ratings.
• The following figure is a wiring example that complies with the National
Electrical Code (NEC) standard for isolation between system and field
power.
• The FP+ terminal on the removable connector is the Voltage connection.
• The FP- terminal on the removable connector is the Common
connection.
• The MCR must be closed for the removable connector to provide power
to the embedded I/O module.
• Install a user-replaceable fuse with overcurrent protection of 4…6 A in
line between the incoming power and the FP+ terminal.
For series A L1 controllers only, you must use a separate, dedicated
Class 2 power supply for the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller and a
separate power supply for the embedded I/O module (see Appendix C,
Connect Field Power to Series A L1 Controllers for I/O Devices ).
Figure 4 - CompactLogix 5370 Series B and C L16ER, L18ER, and L18ERM Controllers, and series A and
C L19 Controllers with Input Devices Powered by a V Terminal on Embedded I/O Module
(Series A [Alternate Series B and C])

Power
Supply 1

MCR

Power 2-wire Prox 3-wire Prox


Supply 2

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 125


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Figure 5 - CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers with Input Devices Powered by a V Terminal on


Embedded I/O Module (Series B and C)

MCR

Power
Supply

2-wire Prox 3-wire Prox

Embedded Output Points

The embedded output points on the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers support 2-wire systems.
The embedded power supply in the controller powers the embedded output points over the
POINTBus backplane.

This figure shows examples of how to connect 2-wire systems to embedded output points
0…7. The same wiring connections can be used with output points 8…15.

IMPORTANT Do not exceed the per point output current rating or the total output
module current rating.
CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers Embedded Digital Output Point Wiring Diagram

Load

Load

Load
Load
Load

Load

Load
Load

126 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

This figure shows an example of how to connect 2-wire systems to embedded output points
0…4 and use an external terminal block with a bus connector strip.

IMPORTANT Do not exceed the per point output current rating or the total output
module current rating.
CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers Embedded Digital Output Point Wiring Diagram

Load

Load

Load
Load
Load

Terminal Block with Bus Connector Strip

Local Expansion Modules


CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers support the use of 1734 POINT I/O™ modules as local
expansion modules along the POINTBus backplane.

IMPORTANT For a full description of how to use 1734 POINT I/O modules, see the
POINT I/O Digital and Analog Modules and POINTBlock I/O Modules,
publication 1734-UM001.

Consider the following when using local expansion modules:


• The controllers support this many local expansion modules.
Maximum 1734 POINT I/O Modules Available as Local Expansion Modules
Cat. No. Local 1734 POINT I/O Modules Supported, Max
1769-L16ER-BB1B 6
1769-L18ER-BB1B
1769-L18ERM-BB1B, 1769-L18ERM-BB1BK 8
1769-L19ER-BB1B, 1769-L19ER-BB1BK
• You can use up to the maximum number of 1734 POINT I/O modules with the
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers that are listed in this table. This condition applies
only as long as the total current drawn by the embedded I/O and local expansion
modules does not exceed the available POINTBus backplane current of 1 A and field
power current of 3 A.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 127


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

IMPORTANT Do not put more than three of the 1734-IT2I or 1734-IR2 modules
on the POINT I/O bus that draws power from the same power
source. This restriction includes power sources such as from
communication adapters or the 1734-EPAC or 1734-EP24DC
expansion power supply modules. The inrush current exceeds
the current limit of the DC to DC converter in the power source.
Based on the configuration of your application, you can use one of the following devices
to make more POINTBus backplane current or field power current available:
- 1734-EP24DC POINT I/O Expansion Power Supply - An expansion power supply is
installed between embedded I/O modules and local expansion modules or between
local expansion modules.
The expansion power supply breaks the available POINTBus backplane current
between the modules to its left and right. With the expansion power supply installed,
the modules to its left can draw up to 1 A of POINTBus backplane current. The
modules to the right of the expansion power supply can draw as much current as is
provided by the expansion power supply.
Additionally, the expansion power supply breaks the available field power current
between the modules to its left and right. With the expansion power supply installed,
the modules to its left can draw up to 3 A of field power current. The modules to the
right of the expansion power supply can draw as much field power current as
allowed by the expansion power supply.
For example, if you need six 1734-IR2 modules as local expansion modules for a 1769-
L18ER-BB1B controller application, you must include the 1734-EP24DC expansion
power supply in the local expansion-module installation.
For more information on the 1734-EP24DC expansion power supply, see the POINT I/O
24V DC Expansion Power Supply Installation Instructions, publication 1734-IN058.
- 1734-FPD POINT I/O Field Power Distributor Module - A field power distributor
module can also be installed between embedded
I/O modules and local expansion modules or between local expansion modules.
The field power distributor module breaks the available field power current between
the modules to its left and right. With the field power distributor module installed, the
modules to its left can draw up to 3 A of field power current. The modules to the right
of the field power distributor module can draw as much field power current as
allowed by the field power distributor.
For more information on the 1734-FPD POINT I/O Field Power Distributor module, see
the POINT I/O Field Power Distributor Module Installation Instructions, publication
1734-IN059.

IMPORTANT Remember, the field power distributor module changes only the
level of field power current available in the system. It does not
affect the level of POINTBus backplane current available.
• You must connect an external 24V DC power source to the FP+ and FP- terminals on the
removable connector on the controller. This connection provides power to input and
output devices that are connected to the local expansion modules.
- Series A controllers require an extra external 24V DC power source for the FP+ and
FP- terminal connections. For more information on how to connect an extra external
power source for series A L1 controller to the FP+ and FP- terminals, see Appendix C,
Connect Field Power to Series A L1 Controllers for I/O Devices
- Series B and C controllers use the external 24V DC power source that is connected to
the VDC+ and VDC- terminals on the controller for the FP+ and FP- terminal
connections. Series B and C controllers can also use an extra external 24V DC power
source for the FP+ and FP- terminal connections.

IMPORTANT Install a user-replaceable fuse with overcurrent protection of


4…6 A in line between the incoming power and the FP+ terminal.

128 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

The field-side power requirement of the local expansion modules of the controller is
24V DC nominally with an input range of 10…28.8V DC.
For more information on how to connect a power source to the FP+ and FP- terminals,
see page 117.
• We recommend that you update all 1734 POINT I/O modules that are designated as local
expansion modules to the most current firmware revision before installing them in a
CompactLogix 5370 L1 system.
• The available RPI range of each local expansion module is 1.0… 750.0 ms and can be
changed by 0.5 ms increments. The default setting is module-dependent.
You can configure RPI values for each local expansion module in your control system.
However, the complete I/O configuration has an impact on the rate at which data is
transmitted in a CompactLogix 5370 L1 control system. For more information, see
page 132.
• Before installing a 1734 POINT I/O module into a CompactLogix 5370 L1 control system,
make sure the I/O module is set to Autobaud. 1734 POINT I/O modules are set to
Autobaud by default.
If you must return a 1734 POINT I/O module to Autobaud, see the POINT I/O Digital and
Analog Modules and POINTBlock I/O Modules, publication 1734-UM001.
• When possible, use specialty 1734 POINT I/O modules to meet unique application
requirements.
• Make sure that there are no empty slots between the controller and local expansion
modules or between local expansion modules.
• The Expansion I/O parameter in the project of the controller must match the number of
local expansion modules that are installed in the system. This requirement is so the
controller can establish connections to the local expansion modules.
• You must use a 1734-232ASC, firmware revision 4.002 or later, to access an RS-232
network in your CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller application.

IMPORTANT Field power is required for the 1734-232ASC module. The module
can’t receive adequate power without the application of
field power.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 129


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Distributed I/O Modules over an EtherNet/IP Network


You can include distributed I/O modules over an EtherNet/IP™ network in your CompactLogix
5370 L1 control system.

Consider the following when using distributed I/O modules over an


EtherNet/IP network:
• Each remote EtherNet/IP adapter included in the system must be counted toward the
maximum number of EtherNet/IP nodes of the controller.
For more information on maximum number of EtherNet/IP nodes, see Chapter 6,
page 102.
• The configurable RPI settings vary depending on which distributed I/O modules are
used in the system.
• To add distributed I/O modules to your CompactLogix 5370 L1 control system, see
page 140.
CompactLogix 5370 L1 Control System That Uses All Three I/O module Options
Local Expansion Modules
Embedded I/O Module

Distributed I/O Modules

130 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Validate I/O Layout You must validate the layout of 1734 POINT I/O modules in your CompactLogix 5370 L1 control
system. Consider the points detailed in this section when validating I/O layout placement.

Set the Number of Local Expansion Modules


You must specify the number of local expansion modules a CompactLogix 5370 L1 control
system requires when creating a project or when you change the number of local expansion
modules. This graphic depicts the module selection.

Each time the controller is powered up, it compares the number of local expansion modules
present on the POINTBus backplane to the Expansion
I/O value. The controller does not allow any I/O connections until the number of local
expansion modules present equals the Expansion I/O value.

Empty Slots and Removal and Insertion Under Power Situations


The POINT I/O system can’t detect an empty terminal base. For this reason, there are
numerous situations in which you can potentially configure a system that is unusable or one
that exercises unintended control.

Follow these rules for I/O system configuration and RIUP of I/O modules.

WARNING: If you insert or remove the module while backplane power is


on, an electric arc can occur. This could cause an explosion in hazardous
location installations.
Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous before
proceeding.

IMPORTANT 1734 POINT I/O modules support RIUP in CompactLogix 5370 L1


control systems.
• A correct I/O system does not have any empty terminal bases. If necessary, you can use
a 1734-ARM POINT I/O Address Reserve module to replace a 1734 POINT I/O module in a
CompactLogix 5370 control system.
• After you cycle power, the controller only enables I/O connections if the number of local
expansion modules present on POINTBus matches the value that is used for the
Expansion I/O parameter in the project.
• If a 1734 POINT I/O module is removed under power, the operation of the other I/O
modules isn’t disrupted.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 131


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

• When you remove an I/O module that has an active connection from the controller, the
controller I/O status indicator flashes green to indicate the condition.

IMPORTANT If you enabled the 'Major Fault On Controller If Connection Fails


While in Run Mode' parameter when configuring the module in
the Studio 5000® environment project, removal of the module
causes the controller to transition to a major fault condition.
• If multiple contiguous modules are removed under power, connections to all modules in
the contiguous missing module set are disallowed until all modules are replaced. The
controller can’t detect an empty base. Therefore, it does not know the physical
positioning of the modules until all missing modules are replaced.
• If a module that separates two sets of contiguous missing modules is removed, the two
sets merge into one set. All modules must be replaced before connections are
permitted to any module in the set.
• If modules of different types are removed and returned to the wrong locations,
attempts to connect to these modules fail during verification of Electronic Keying.

IMPORTANT If Electronic Keying is set to Disable Keying, no verification of


electronic keying occurs and unintended control can occur.
• If modules of the same type are removed and returned to the wrong locations, they
accept connections from the controller. The modules also reconfigure with the correct
data once they pass their electronic keying check.

Estimate Requested Packet Interval


The requested packet interval (RPI) defines the frequency at which the controller sends data
to and receives data from I/O modules. You set an RPI rate for each I/O module in your system.

The CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers attempt to scan an I/O module at the configured RPI
rate. For individual I/O modules, a module RPI overlap minor fault (further described on
page 133) occurs if there are enough I/O modules with RPI rates set too fast that they can’t all
be serviced in the allotted interval.

The configuration parameters for a system determine the impact on actual RPI rates. These
configuration factors can affect the effective scan frequency for any individual module:
• Other 1734 POINT I/O module RPI rate settings
• Number of other 1734 POINT I/O modules in the system
• Types of other 1734 POINT I/O modules in the system
• Application user task priorities

132 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

In general, follow these guidelines when setting the RPI rates in a


CompactLogix 5370 L1 control system:
• For digital I/O modules:
- 1…2 modules can be scanned in 2 ms.
- 3…4 modules can be scanned in 4 ms.
- 5…8 modules can be scanned in 8 ms.

IMPORTANT When considering digital I/O modules, remember that they can
be the embedded I/O module on the controller or 1734 POINT I/O
modules that are used as Local Expansion Modules. Therefore,
the consideration for using two modules can be the embedded
I/O module and a 1734 POINT I/O module or two 1734 POINT I/O
modules.
• For specialty and analog I/O modules (except 1734-485ASC modules):
- One module can be scanned at 20 ms.
- For each additional module, add 20 ms.
For example, if a CompactLogix 5370 L1 control system uses two analog modules, the
module can be scanned in 40 ms.
• For 1734-485ASC modules, the total data size for all ASC modules determines the RPI
rates:
- For total data size less than 20 bytes, each module can be scanned in 20 ms.
- For data size greater than 20 bytes, use the size value as the RPI.
For example, if the total data size is 40 bytes, each ASC module can be scanned in 40
ms.

You aren’t required to set individual RPI values of 1734 POINT I/O modules to the values listed
previously. For example, if your application scans one or two modules, you do not have to use
RPI rates of 2 ms. Remember, though, that higher RPI rates result in less frequent data scans.

The RPI shows how quickly modules can be scanned, not how quickly an application can use
the data. The RPI is asynchronous to the program scan. Other factors, such as program
execution duration, affect I/O throughput.

Module Faults Related to RPI Estimates


When following the guidelines described on page 133, most CompactLogix 5370 L1 control
systems operate as expected.

Some systems that follow the guidelines can experience minor faults that are described in this
table.

Name Fault Information Condition In Which Fault Occurs


This fault is logged when the current RPI update of an I/O module overlaps
with its previous RPI update. The Minor Faults tab in the Controller
Properties dialog box indicates which module that the RPI overlaps.
(Type 03) I/O fault If multiple I/O modules experience the fault, the application indicates that
(Code 94) Module RPI the fault occurred on the first such I/O module. Typically, it’s an I/O module
Module RPI overlap detected with a lower RPI rate and/or an I/O module with large input/output data
Module Slot = x, where x sizes. For example, the 1734-232ASC and 1734-485ASC modules use large
Overlap is the slot number of input/output data sizes.
the I/O module in the I/ Once the fault is cleared from the first I/O module, the application
O Configuration section indicates the next module that experiences the fault. This pattern
continues until the fault is cleared from all affected I/O modules.
To avoid this fault, set the RPI rate of the I/O modules to a higher
numerical value.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 133


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Calculate System Power Consumption


An embedded 24V DC nominal, non-isolated power supply with an input range of 10…28.8V DC
powers the CompactLogix 5370 L1 control system.

The embedded power supply provides 1 A @ 5V DC to the POINTBus backplane to power all
system components, including local expansion modules, in most system configurations. Local
expansion modules include 1734 POINT I/O modules.

In some circumstances, you can configure a system that requires more current than the
embedded power supply of the system provides. This type of configuration results from using
a combination of local expansion modules that, when combined with current consumption of
the rest of the system, exceeds 1 A @ 5V DC.

In this case, you can take any of the following actions to make sure that your system
configuration has enough power:
• Insert a 1734-EP24DC POINT I/O expansion power supply between local expansion
modules to increase the POINTBus backplane power.
• Insert a 1734-FPD POINT I/O Field Potential Distribution module between local expansion
modules to renew field power or change the field power from DC to AC. The Field
Potential Distribution module separates DC I/O modules from AC I/O modules on the
same POINTBus.

IMPORTANT The 1734-FPD POINT I/O Field Power Distributor is required if the
devices connected to the local expansion modules consume
more than 3 A.

Physical Placement of I/O Modules


Before you physically install the I/O modules, you must assemble, mount, and ground the
system as described in Chapter 2, page 21.

134 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Use the Event Task The CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers support the use of an Event task with their embedded
input points. You can configure embedded input point terminals to trigger an Event task if a
change of state (COS) occurs.

IMPORTANT When using the Event task with the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers,
consider these points:
• You can use the Event task only with Logix Designer application, version
21.00.00 and later.
• You can use the Event task only with the embedded input points of the
controller. You can’t use the Event task with input points in the local
expansion modules, for example, a 1734-IB4 module.
• You can use the Event task only if the input point has an input data
state change.
• An event is recognized only when it maintains the same state for at least
the duration of the input filter time specified.
• Configure the Event task at a rate that stops task overlap conditions.
• Configure the Event task at a rate that is likely to succeed.
A 2 ms signal width is the minimum pulse width that can be used at
which the Event task succeeds.
You can configure multiple embedded input points to trigger an Event task. However, we
recommend that you enable COS for only one point. If you enable COS for multiple points, a
task overlap of the Event task can occur.

You can configure an Event task to trigger if one of these events occurs:
• An event occurs on one point on an input module.
• A trigger event does not occur in a time interval.
You configure whether the task updates output modules at the end of the task. After the task
executes, it does not execute again until the event occurs again. Each Event task requires a
trigger.

This table describes the triggers for an Event task available in a CompactLogix 5370 L1 control
system.
Trigger Description
The input point triggers the Event task that is based on the change of state (COS)
Input Data State Change configuration for the point. The COS configuration is set on the Module Definition
dialog box.
Only one consumed tag can trigger an Event task. Use an Immediate Output (IOT)
Consumed Tag instruction in the producing controller to signal the production of new data.
Axis Registration 1 or 2 A registration input triggers the Event task.
Axis Watch A watch position triggers the Event task.
The coarse update period for the motion group triggers the execution of the motion
Motion Group Execution planner and the Event task. Because the motion planner interrupts all other tasks, it
executes first.
EVENT Instruction Multiple EVENT instructions can trigger the same task.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 135


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

For more information on Event tasks, see the following publications:


• Logix 5000™ Controllers Common Procedures Programming Manual, publication
1756-PM001
• Using Event Tasks with Logix 5000 Controllers,
publication LOGIX-WP003
Complete the following steps to configure the Event task.
1. Open the project.
2. Right-click Embedded Discrete_IO and select Properties.

3. On the Module Properties dialog box, complete the following steps.


a. Select the Input Configuration tab.
b. Enable COS for the digital input points on which a state change, that is, Off to On or
On to Off, triggers the Event task.
c. Set the desired input filter time for each COS-enabled input point.

IMPORTANT An event is recognized only when it maintains the same state for
at least the duration of the input filter time specified.
d. Select OK.

136 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

4. Right-click Tasks and select New Task.

5. On the New Task dialog box, complete the following steps.


a. Name the task.
b. Change the task type to Event.
c. Select the trigger.
d. Select the tag.
e. If desired, set a time so the Event task executes if no event occurs with the value.
On the following example dialog box, the time is 10 ms. If no event occurs for 10 ms,
the Event task executes.
f. Set the task priority.
The default Event task priority level is 10. For more information about Event tasks,
see Using Event Tasks with Logix 5000 Controllers white paper, LOGIX-WP003.
g. Make more desired configuration changes.
h. Select OK.

The new Event task appears in the Controller Organizer.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 137


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Configure I/O Complete these steps to add a 1734 POINT I/O module to your CompactLogix 5370 L1 control
system.
1. Right-click PointIO and select New Module.

You can also right-click Expansion I/O.


2. Select the desired I/O module and select Create.

The New Module dialog box appears.


3. Configure the new I/O module as necessary and select OK.

138 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Common Configuration Parameters


While the configuration options vary from module to module, there are some common options
you typically configure when using 1734 POINT I/O modules in a CompactLogix 5370 L1 control
system, as described in this table.
CompactLogix 5370 L1 Control System Configuration Options
Configuration Option Description
The RPI specifies the interval at which data is transmitted or received over a connection. For POINTBus backplane local expansion
modules, data is transmitted to the controller at the RPI.
When scanned on the local bus or over an EtherNet/IP network, I/O modules are scanned at the RPI specified in the module
configuration. Typically, you configure an RPI in milliseconds (ms).
Requested packet interval (RPI) • For local expansion modules, the range is 1.0…750 ms and the RPI must be configured in 0.5 ms increments. That is, you can’t set
the RPI to a value of 2.3 ms. It must be 2.0 or 2.5.
• For remote I/O modules over an EtherNet/IP network, the range is 2.0…750 ms and the RPI must be configured in 1.0 ms
increments. That is, you can’t set the RPI to a value of 2.3 ms. It must be 2.0 or 3.0.
Set of configuration parameters that affect data transmission between the controller and the I/O module. The parameters include
the following:
• Series - Hardware series of the module.
• Revision - Major and minor firmware revision levels that are used on the module.
Module definition
• Electronic Keying - See LOGIX-AT001 for Electronic Keying information.
• Connection - Type of connection between the controller that writes the configuration and the I/O module, such as Output.
• Data format - Type of data that is transferred between the controller and I/O module and what tags are generated when the
configuration is complete.
This option determines how the controller is affected if the connection to an I/O module fails in Run mode or if the controller is
unable to establish a connection to the module. You can configure the project so that a connection failure causes a major fault on
Major Fault on Controller If Connection the controller or not. The default setting is for the option to be disabled.
Fails While in Run Mode For example, if this option is enabled and an I/O module is removed while in Run mode, a major fault occurs on the controller. The
default setting for the embedded I/O module is that this option is enabled. The default setting for local expansion modules is that
this option is disabled.

I/O Connections
A CompactLogix 5370 L1 control system uses connections to transmit I/O data. This table
describes the connection types.

IMPORTANT You can only use direct connections with the local expansion modules
in a CompactLogix 5370 L1 control system.

CompactLogix 5370 L1 Control System I/O Module Connections


Connection Description
A direct connection is a real-time, data-transfer link between the controller and an I/O module. The controller maintains and
monitors the connection. Any break in the connection, such as a module fault, causes the controller to set fault status bits in the
Direct data area that is associated with the module.
Typically, analog I/O modules, diagnostic I/O modules, and specialty modules require direct connections.
Rack-optimized connections aren’t available with local expansion modules that are used in CompactLogix 5370 L1 control systems.
For digital
I/O modules, you can select rack-optimized connections.
This option is used with distributed I/O modules and the Rack Optimization connection selection is made when configuring the
Rack-optimized remote adapter. For example, if you want to use a rack-optimized connection with digital I/O modules in a remote 1734 POINT I/O
system, you configure the 1734-AENT(R) module to use a connection type of Rack Optimization.
A rack-optimized connection consolidates connection usage between the controller and all digital I/O modules in a remote chassis
or on one DIN rail. Rather than having individual, direct connections for each I/O module, there’s one connection for the entire rack
(or DIN rail).

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 139


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Configure Distributed I/O Your CompactLogix 5370 L1 control system can use distributed I/O modules on an EtherNet/IP
network.
Modules on an EtherNet/IP
Network IMPORTANT When adding distributed I/O modules, remember to count the remote
Ethernet adapter to remain within the maximum number of EtherNet/IP
network nodes limitation for your controller.
The distributed I/O modules that are connected to the controller via the
remote Ethernet adapter aren’t counted toward the maximum Ethernet
node limit for the controller.
For example, a 1769-L16ER-BB1B controller supports up to four Ethernet
nodes. You can add up to four remote Ethernet adapters to the I/O
Configuration section because each remote adapter counts against the
node count. However, you can add as many remote I/O modules to the
chassis of the adapter as necessary. Remote I/O modules do not count
against the node count.
For more information on node limitations, see page 102.
Complete these steps to configure distributed I/O modules on an EtherNet/IP network.
1. Right-click Ethernet and select New Module.

2. Select the desired Ethernet adapter and select Create.

The New Module dialog box appears.

140 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

3. Configure the new Ethernet adapter as necessary and select OK.

4. Right-click the new adapter and select New Module.

5. Select the desired I/O module and select Create.

The New Module dialog box appears.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 141


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

6. Configure the new I/O module as necessary and select OK.

7. To add all desired distributed I/O modules to the project, repeat these steps.

The following graphic is an example of a 1769-L18ERM-BB1B control system that uses


distributed I/O modules over an EtherNet/IP network.

1794-AENT FLEX™ I/O Adapter Connected via 1734-AENTR POINT I/O Adapter with
a 1783-ETAP EtherNet/IP Tap POINT I/O Modules

PanelView™ Plus Terminal


Computer with Ethernet Port

1769-L18ERM-BB1B Control System


Kinetix® 6500 Drive and Motor Kinetix 350 Drive Connected via a
1783-ETAP EtherNet/IP Tap

142 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Monitor I/O Modules With CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers, you can use the following options to monitor I/O
modules:
• QuickView™ Pane below the Controller Organizer
• Connection tab in the Module Properties dialog box
• Programming logic to monitor fault data so you can act

When a fault occurs on an I/O module, a yellow triangle on the module listing in the Controller
Organizer alerts you to the fault.

The following graphic shows the Quick View Pane, which indicates the type of fault.

To see the fault description on the Connection tab in Module Properties dialog box, complete
these steps.
1. In the I/O Configuration, right-click the faulted I/O module and select Properties.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 143


Chapter 7 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

2. To diagnose the issue, select the Connection tab and use the fault description, in the
Module Fault section.

3. To close the dialog box and remedy the issue, select OK.

Bus Off Detection and Recovery


When the POINTBus backplane experiences a bus off condition, the CompactLogix 5370 L1
controller indicates this condition via a BUS OFF minor fault (Type 03, Code 01). When this fault
occurs, the connections between the controller and I/O modules are broken.

Complete these steps to identify the source of the BUS OFF minor fault.
1. Make sure the number of local expansion modules in the project matches the number of
modules that are physically installed in the system.
2. Make sure that all mounting bases are locked and I/O modules are securely installed on
mounting bases.
3. Make sure all 1734 POINT I/O modules are configured to use the Autobaud rate.

IMPORTANT You can’t change the Autobaud setting for a 1734 POINT I/O when
the module is installed in a CompactLogix 5370 L1 control
system.
If you must return a 1734 POINT I/O module to Autobaud, see the
POINT I/O Digital and Analog Modules and POINTBlock I/O
Modules, publication 1734-UM001.
If these steps do not remedy the fault condition, contact Rockwell Automation® technical
support.

144 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8

Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370


L2 Controllers

Select I/O Modules This chapter details the I/O module options CompactLogix™ 5370 L2 control systems offer.

Embedded I/O Modules


CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers provide embedded I/O modules. The catalog number
determines the number and type of points. This table describes which embedded I/O modules
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers support.
Sinking/ High-speed Universal
Sourcing Sourcing Analog
24V DC Digital High-speed Counter Analog
Cat. No. 24V DC Output
Digital Input Output Points Counters Output Input Points
Points Points
Points
1769-L24ER-QB1B - - - -
1769-L24ER-QBFC1B, 16 16
1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK 4 4 4 2
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B

IMPORTANT Remember the following when using the embedded I/O modules on
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers:
• 1769-L24ER-QB1B controller - The digital input points and digital output
points are on one embedded I/O module. Therefore, the
1769-L24ER-QB1B controller is considered to have one embedded I/O
module.
• 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B, 1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK, and 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B
controllers - The digital input points and digital output points are on one
embedded I/O module. The high-speed counter input/output points,
universal analog input points, and analog output points are on another
single embedded I/O module. Therefore, the 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B, 1769-
L24ER-QBFC1BK, and 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers are considered to
have two embedded I/O modules.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 145


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

You configure an RPI rate for the embedded I/O modules to establish the time intervals at
which data is transmitted between the controller and each embedded I/O point. The available
RPI range of the embedded I/O points is 0.5… 750.0 ms and can be changed by 0.5 ms
increments. The default setting is 20 ms.

IMPORTANT • If you attempt to use an RPI value that is not valid, the application
automatically rounds the value down to the closest 0.5 ms increment
when you apply the change.
For example, if you set the RPI = 1.75 ms, when you select Apply or OK,
the value is rounded down to 1.5 ms and applied.
• The RPI value for an embedded I/O module is intended to establish a
time interval at which data is transmitted. However, the configuration of
your CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system can affect the actual time
interval of data transmission.
For more information regarding estimating the RPI value, see page 175.

Embedded Digital I/O Points

The embedded digital I/O module on CompactLogix 5370 L2 contains 16 24V DC sinking inputs
and 16 24V DC sourcing outputs. The inputs can be configured to use digital filtering by input
group. Filter times can be specified for OFF to ON and ON to OFF.
Group 0 is used to configure inputs 0…7. Group 1 is used to configure inputs
8…15. The default filter time for each group is 8 ms. You can adjust the filter times to 0.0 ms,
0.1 ms, 0.5 ms, 1.0 ms, 2.0 ms, and 4.0 ms, as shown in this graphic.

IMPORTANT The embedded digital I/O points on the 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B and 1769-
L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers are organized and wired the same.
CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers Embedded Digital I/O Module Wiring Termination Points

Digital Input
Points

Digital Output
Points

146 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers Embedded Digital Input Point Wiring Diagram

+ DC (Sinking)
- DC (Sourcing)

24V DC

- DC (Sinking)
+ DC (Sourcing)

CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers Embedded Digital Output Point Wiring Diagram

+ DC

24V DC

- DC

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 147


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Embedded Analog I/O Points

IMPORTANT The embedded analog I/O points are available on only the
1769-L24ER-QBFC1B and 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers.

The 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B and 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers support four embedded


universal analog inputs that can function as differential or single-ended inputs. This capability
applies only if you do not use RTDs. If you use RTDs in your system, you can use up to two RTDs
or a combination of one RTD and two universal analog inputs. The 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B and
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers also support two embedded standard analog outputs that can
function as single-ended outputs. The inputs and outputs are considered channels. Each
channel configuration offers multiple configuration options.

This table lists the available embedded analog input channel types and ranges for the channel
type. The configuration choices are made on the Input Configuration tab of the Module
Properties dialog box, as shown.
Input Types and Ranges
Input Type Input Ranges Project Configuration
• Type -50…+50 mV
• Type -100…+100 mV
• 0…5V
Voltage
• 1…5V
• 0…10V
• -10V…10V
• 0…20 mA
Current
• 4…20 mA
• J
• K at 1370…1372 °C (2498…2501.6 °F)
• K at -200…+1370 °C (-328…+2498 °F)
• T
• E
Thermocouple • S and R at 0…1768 °C (32…3214.4 °F)
• S and R at -50…0 °C (-58…+32 °F)
• B at 300…1820 °C (572…3308 °F)
• B at 250…300 °C (482…572 °F)
• N
• C
• 100 Platinum 385
• 200 Platinum 385
• 500 Platinum 385
• 1000 Platinum 385
• 100 Platinum 3916
• 200 Platinum 3916
RTD
• 500 Platinum 3916
• 1000 Platinum 3916
• 10 Copper 426
• 120 Nickel 618
• 120 Nickel 672
• 604 Nickel-Iron 518
• 0…150 
• 0…500 
Resistance
• 0…1000 
• 0…3000 

148 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

This figure shows the embedded analog I/O points and how each termination point is used
with different analog input types.

IMPORTANT The embedded analog I/O points on the 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B and 1769-
L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers are organized and wired the same.
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Controller Embedded Analog I/O Wiring Termination Points

Terminal Point Labels Terminal Point Labels

Thermocouple Input Type Connections RTD and Resistance Input Type Connections

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 149


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

This figure shows an example of ungrounded and grounded thermocouple wiring diagrams on
a 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controller.
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Controller Thermocouple Wiring Diagrams

Ungrounded Thermocouple Grounded Thermocouple

Earth Ground Earth Ground

IMPORTANT You must order Cold Junction Connectors, catalog number


1769-CJC, separately from the CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers.
This figure shows an example of devices with differential connections that are wired to the
embedded analog inputs on a 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controller when it’s operating with voltage
or current input types.
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Controller Differential Connections Diagrams

Voltage Input Type Current Input Type


Differential Voltage Differential Current
Connections Connections
Differential Differential
Voltage Current
Transmitter Transmitter

Earth Ground Earth Ground


Ground the Ground the
shield locally at shield locally at
the module. the module.

IMPORTANT For both input types, we recommend that you use Belden #8761
or equivalent cable.

150 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

This figure shows an example of devices with single-ended connections that are wired to the
embedded analog inputs on a 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controller when it’s operating with voltage
or current input types.
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Controller Single-ended Connections Wiring Diagrams

Voltage Input Type Current Input Type


Single-ended Voltage Single-ended Current
Connections Connections

Voltage Transmitter Current Transmitter

Power Signal Signal Power


Supply Ground Supply

Earth Earth

IMPORTANT For single-ended connections, remember the following:


• For both input types, we recommend that you use Belden #8761
or equivalent cable.
• The mV ranges with the Voltage input type do not support
single-ended encoder wiring.
• All commons are electrically tied together in the controller.
• If multiple power supplies are used, the commons must have the
same reference.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 151


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

This figure shows an example of 2-wire, 3-wire, and 4-wire RTD/Resistance wiring diagrams
on a 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controller.
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B RTD/Resistance Wiring Diagrams

2-wire Device
Wiring Diagram

Earth

3-wire Device
Wiring Diagram

Earth

4-wire Device
Wiring Diagram

IMPORTANT For all wiring diagrams, we recommend that you use Belden
#83503 or 9533 cable.

152 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

This table lists the available embedded analog output channel types and ranges for the
channel type. The configuration choices are made on the Output Configuration tab of the
Module Properties dialog box, as shown in the table.
Output Types and Ranges
Output Type Output Ranges Project Configuration
• -10…10V
• 0…5V
Voltage
• 0…10V
• 1…5V

• 4…20 mA
Current
• 0…20 mA

This figure shows an example of wiring input devices to the analog output points on the 1769-
L27ERM-QBFC1B controller when it’s operating in voltage or current mode.
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Controller Analog Output Wiring Diagrams

Voltage Analog Current Analog


Output Wiring Output Wiring
Diagram Diagram

Voltage
Load Current
Load

Earth Ground Earth Ground

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 153


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Embedded High-speed Counters

IMPORTANT The embedded high-speed counters are available on only the


1769-L24ER-QBFC1B and 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers.

The 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B and 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers support four embedded high-


speed counters. Each counter is a differential input. Therefore, two input terminals are
required for one counter. For example, the A0+ and A0- terminals are required for counter A0.

The L2 embedded high-speed counters operate like the 1769-HSC module. See 1769-UM006 for
further information.

Each counter uses differential inputs that are compatible with standard differential-line driver
output devices and single-ended devices. This shows the embedded high-speed counter input
points.

IMPORTANT The embedded high-speed counter points on the 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B and


1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers are organized and wired the same.
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Controller Embedded High-speed Counter Wiring Termination Points

This figure shows an example of a differential encoder that is wired to the embedded high-
speed counter inputs on a 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controller.
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Controller Differential Encoder with High-speed Counter Input Wiring Diagram

Cable

External
Power Shield
Supply
Earth

Shield/Housing
Only connect if housing is
electronically isolated from the motor

154 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

This figure shows an example of a single-ended encoder that is wired to the embedded high-
speed counter inputs on a 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controller.
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Controller Single-ended Encoder with High-speed Counter Input Wiring
Diagram

Cable

Shield
External
Power
Supply
Earth

Shield/Housing
Only connect if housing is electronically
isolated from the motor and ground.

The embedded high-speed counter also supports four output points. This figure shows a
wiring diagram for the embedded high-speed counter output points.

IMPORTANT The embedded high-speed counter points on the 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B


and 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers are organized and wired the same.
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Controller Embedded High-speed Counter Output Wiring Diagram

+DC

5/24V DC

-DC

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 155


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Wiring the Embedded I/O Modules

Complete these steps to wire the input and output points on the CompactLogix 5370 L2
controller.
1. Verify that the control system isn’t powered.
2. Strip 10 mm (0.39 in.) insulation from the end of the wire.
3. Push the wire into the open terminal until it’s secure.
If your wire is too thin to push into the open terminal for secure placement, we
recommend that you connect the wire to a ferrule and insert it into the open terminal.

4. Repeat step 3 for all embedded I/O wires that are needed in your application.

To remove a wire from the removable connector, complete these steps.


1. Verify that the control system isn’t powered.
2. Use a small screwdriver to push the spring release clip and pull out the wire.

156 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

You can use a continuity tester to determine if the connection point is operating correctly, that
is, the connection point is a complete circuit. You use a continuity tester if any issues arise
with a removable connector and you suspect that a connection point can no longer be
functioning as a complete circuit.

The indication mechanism, for example, a light that illuminates on the tester, varies by
continuity tester. The following example graphic shows a continuity tester with one
connection point. In this case, if the circuit is operating correctly, the indicator light turns on.

Insert a continuity tester into the suspected I/O connection point as shown in the following
graphic.

Continuity Tester

Small hole on
opposite from
termination point
in removable
connector.

Remove and Replace the Connector

Complete these steps to remove and replace an embedded I/O module connector.
1. Verify that the control system isn’t powered.
2. Compress the small release clips at the top and bottom of the connector and tilt the top
of the connector away from the module.

3. Pull the connector away from the module and disconnect any wires.
4. Connect the wires to the replacement connector.
5. Push the connector back into the module and engage the clips to secure the connector.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 157


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Determine Embedded
Module Update Time IMPORTANT This section applies to the 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B and 1769-L27ERM-
QBFC1B controllers because only those controllers have
embedded universal analog input points.
The module update time is the time that the module requires to sample and convert the input
signals of all enabled analog input channels and provide the resulting data values to the
controller.

You calculate the module update time by adding the update times for each enabled analog
input channel on the module. Each channel update time calculation is the result of several
configuration choices that are described in the following section.

Channel Update Times


A combination of the update times that are detailed in this section determines the channel
update time for an enabled analog input channel.

Channel Input Type and Filter Frequency Selection Update Time

When you enable an embedded analog input channel, you must select an input type and a filter
frequency for that input. The selections that you make determine the value that is required
when calculating channel update time.

IMPORTANT Each channel input type has multiple ranges or types. For example, a
voltage input type can use one of six voltage ranges. Regardless of which
voltage range the channel uses, the channel update time remains the
same.

This table shows the channel update times for each channel input type and filter frequency
selection.
Channel Update Times
Channel Update Times Based on Input Type Selection
Filter Frequency
Selection(1) Voltage, Current, or Thermocouple Resistance or RTD Input Type
Input Type
10 Hz 307 ms 614 ms
50 Hz 67 ms 134 ms
60 Hz 57 ms 114 ms
250 Hz 19 ms 38 ms
500 Hz 13 ms 26 ms
1 kHz 11 ms 22 ms
(1) Filter frequency selections are made on the Input Configuration tab of the Module Properties dialog box.

158 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Cold Junction Compensation Update Times

You must account for more voltage at the junction of the thermocouple field wires and the
input point. This condition applies when you use any of the thermocouple input types on your
embedded analog input. More voltage can alter the input signal on that point and, therefore,
affect the update time of that channel.
The process to account for increased voltage at an input point by using a thermocouple type
input is cold junction compensation (CJC). You enable CJC for a given channel on the Input
Configuration tab of the Module Configuration dialog box, as shown in the following graphic.

By default, CJC is disabled. You must clear the Disable Cold Junction Compensation checkbox
to use CJC for a given channel.

You aren’t required to enable CJC for a channel by using the thermocouple input type. If you
enable CJC and select Update Cold Junction Compensation every other scan, an extra update
time exists on the channel. This extra update time increases the overall channel update time.

The filter frequency selection for the channel determines the CJC update time. This table
shows the CJC update times that are based on filter frequency selections.
Channel Update Times
Filter Frequency Selection(1) CJC Update Time
10 Hz 614 ms
50 Hz 134 ms
60 Hz 114 ms
250 Hz 38 ms
500 Hz 26 ms
1 kHz 22 ms
(1) Filter frequency selections are made on the Input Configuration tab of the Module Properties dialog box.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 159


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

IMPORTANT Keep the following in mind when calculating the CJC update time:
• If multiple input channels are configured to use a thermocouple input
type and another filter value is selected for each, the filter frequency
selection with the slowest update time determines the CJC update time.
For example, if one input channel uses a thermocouple input with a 50
Hz filter frequency and another input channel uses a thermocouple
input with a 60 Hz filter frequency, the CJC channel update time is 134
ms.
• The CJC update time that increases overall module update time is only
used once regardless of the number of input channels on a module that
have CJC enabled to scan every other scan.
In other words, if your module uses a filter frequency selection of 250
Hz and includes three channels with CJC enabled to scan every other
scan, you add only one instance of CJC update time to the overall
equation. Instead of including 38 ms for each channel, you include 38
ms once.

Open Circuit Detection Update Time

Open circuit detection is used to verify that the field wiring is physically connected to the
embedded analog input point. If this feature is enabled and the field wiring is disconnected
from the input, the application alerts you to the condition and an open wire bit is set for the
respective input channel in the tags for the project.

Open circuit detection can be enabled or disabled on any channel input type except for an
input channel that is configured to use the 0…20 mA input range. The configuration selection
is made on the Input Configuration tab on the Module Properties dialog box, as shown in the
following graphic. The configuration choice, that is, enabled or disabled, is the result of an
Open Circuit Response selection for the channel.

To disable open circuit detection, select Disable. To enable open circuit detection, select any
of the other four options.

This table describes the module response that is associated with each enable selection.
Open Circuit Detection Response Definitions
Response Option Definition
Sets the input data value to the full upper-scale value of the channel data word. The
Upscale selected input type and data format determines the full-scale value.
Sets the input data value to full lower-scale value of channel data word. The selected input
Downscale type and data format determines the low scale value.
Last State Sets the input data value to the last input value before the detection of the open-circuit.
Zero Sets the input data value to 0 to force the channel data word to 0.

When you enable open circuit detection for an input channel, an extra update time is used to
calculate the overall channel type. The increase in channel update time is 11 ms for each
channel that enables open circuit detection response.

160 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

This table lists example module update times that are based on channel configurations.
Example Module Update Times
Example Enabled Analog Input Module Update
Channel Update Time Calculations
Channel Configuration Time
• Channel 0:
– Input type = Current 57 ms 57 ms
– Filter Frequency Selection = 60 Hz
• Channel 0:
– Input type = Current
– Filter Frequency Selection = 60 Hz Channel 0 update time + Channel 2 update time 171 ms
• Channel 2: 57 ms + 114 ms
– Input type = RTD
– Filter Frequency Selection = 60 Hz
• Channel 0:
– Input type = Voltage
– Filter Frequency Selection = 60 Hz (Channel 0 update time + Open Circuit Detection
– Open Circuit Detection = Enabled time) + Channel 2 update time 682 ms
• Channel 2: (57 ms + 11 ms) + 614 ms
– Input type = RTD
– Filter Frequency Selection = 10 Hz
• Channel 0:
– Input type = RTD
– Filter Frequency Selection = 10 Hz
– Open Circuit Detection = Enabled
• Channel 2: (Channel 0 update time + Open Circuit Detection
– Input type = Thermocouple time) + (Channel 2 update time + Open Circuit
– Filter Frequency Selection = 60 Hz Detection time) + (Channel 3 update time + Open
Circuit Detection time) + CJC Update time 831 ms
– CJC = Enabled
– Open Circuit Detection = Enabled (614 ms + 11 ms) + (57 ms + 11 ms)
• Channel 3: + (13 ms + 11 ms) + 114 ms(1)
– Input type = Thermocouple
– Filter Frequency Selection = 500 Hz
– CJC = Enabled
– Open Circuit Detection = Enabled
(1) If you select multiple thermocouples for your system, use the largest CJC Update time for your calculations.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 161


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Embedded Analog I/O The section describes the data table structures for the embedded analog I/O modules on the
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers. The embedded analog
Modules Data Arrays I/O modules have arrays for the following data:
• Input data
• Output data
• Configuration data

You can access the data via the tags in the application.

IMPORTANT The analog I/O modules data structures apply to only the
1769-L24ER-QBFC1B, 1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK, and 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B
controllers.
The 1769-L24ER-QB1B controller does not have an embedded analog
I/O module.

162 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Input Array
The input data array for the embedded analog I/O module contains 11 words as described in
this table. This array is read-only and the default value for all bits is 0.
CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller Embedded Analog I/O Module Input Data Array
Bit
Word
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 S Analog Read (Input) Data Value Channel 0
1 S Analog Read (Input) Data Value Channel 1
2 S Analog Read (Input) Data Value Channel 2
3 S Analog Read (Input) Data Value Channel 3
4 Nu Timestamp Value
5 Nu UI4 OI4 OC4 OC3 OC2 OC1 OC0 Nu SI4 SI3 SI2 SI1 SI0
6 LI3 HI3 UI3 OI3 LI2 HI2 UI2 OI2 LI1 HI1 UI1 OI1 LI0 HI0 UI0 OI0
7 S Cold Junction Compensation Value
8 S Output Data Loopback/Echo Channel 0
9 S Output Data Loopback/Echo Channel 1
10 Nu UO1 OO1 Nu UO0 OO0 Nu SO1 SO0
Analog Read (Input) Data Value Channel x is the data that is read from the field device that is connected to the channel.
Timestamp Value is the timestamp of when data was received at the corresponding channel.
Cold Junction Compensation value is the converted CJC data. The data is calculated in the following manner:
• If the CJC is open, the converted value is 25 °C (77 °F).
• If the CJC isn’t opened and the Update CJC sensor every other scan option is disabled, the converted value is 25 °C (77 °F).
• If the CJC isn’t opened and the Update CJC sensor every other scan option is enabled, the converted value is the measured temperature.
S Sign bit
Nu Bit not used
SIx General status bit for an input channel. Bits 0…3 are for input channels. Bit 4 is for CJC. If the bit is 0, the channel is operating normally. If the bit is 1, a fault has
occurred on the channel.
Overrange alarm bit for an input channel.
OIx 0 = Channel is operating normally
1 = Input signal is over normal range.
Underrange alarm bit for an input channel.
UIx 0 = Channel is operating normally
1 = For bits 0…3, that is, input channels, the input signal is under the normal range. For bit 4, that is, channel using the thermocouple/mV, RTD/Resistance input
type, the input value equals the minimum value of the range.
Where:
High alarm bit for an input channel 0.
HIx 0 = Channel is operating normally
1 = Input signal is above the user-defined range
Low alarm bit for an input channel 0.
LIx 0 = Channel is operating normally
1 = Input signal is below the user-defined range.
Open circuit detection bit.
OCx 0 = Channel isn’t experiencing an open circuit condition
1 = Channel is experiencing an open circuit condition
General status bit for output channel 0 or 1.
SOx 0 = Channel operating normally
1 = A fault has occurred on the channel
Overrange alarm bit for output channel 0 or 1.
OOx 0 = Channel is operating normally
1 = Output signal is over the normal range
Underrange alarm bit for output channel 0 or 1.
UOx 0 = Channel is operating normally
1 = Output signal is below the normal range

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 163


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Output Array
The embedded analog I/O output image array of the module contains four words as described
in this table. This array is write-only and the default value for all bits is 0.
CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller Embedded Analog I/O Module Output Data Array
Bit
Word
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 S Analog Output Data Value Channel 0
1 S Analog Output Data Value Channel 1
CL CH CL CH CL CH CL CH
2 Nu I3 I3 I2 I2 I1 I1 I0 I0
CL CH CL CH
3 Nu O1 O1 O0 O0
Analog Output Data Value Channel x is the data that is written to the channel.
S Sign bit
Nu Bit not used
Use this bit to cancel High Process Alarm Latch functionality for an input.
CH 0 = Do not cancel
Ix 1 = Cancel the alarm latch
Use this bit to cancel Low Process Alarm Latch functionality for an input.
Where: CL 0 = Do not cancel
Ix 1 = Cancel the alarm latch
Use this bit to cancel High Process Alarm Latch functionality for an output.
CH 0 = Do not cancel
Ox 1 = Cancel the alarm latch
Use this bit to cancel Low Process Alarm Latch functionality for an output.
CL 0 = Do not cancel
Ox 1 = Cancel the alarm latch

Configuration Array
The embedded analog I/O configuration image array of the module contains 43 words as
described in this table.
CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller Embedded Analog I/O Module Configuration Image Array
Bit
Word
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 Real Time Sample Value
1 ETS Nu
2 EC Nu EA AL EI EO Open Circuit Ch0 0V Adj Filter Setting ChI0
3 Wire & CLCD TU ChIo Nu Inpt Dta Fm ChI0 Nu Inpt Tp/RngeSel ChI0
4 S Process Alarm High Data Value Universal Input Channel 0
5 S Process Alarm Low Data Value Universal Input Channel 0
6 S Alarm Dead Band Value Universal Input Channel 0
7 Nu
8 EC Nu EA AL EI EO Open Circuit ChI 1 0V Adj Filter Setting ChI1
9 Nu TU ChI1 Nu Inpt Dta Fm ChI1 Nu Inpt Tp/RngeSel ChI1
10 S Process Alarm High Data Value Universal Input Channel 1
11 S Process Alarm Low Data Value Universal Input Channel 1
12 S Alarm Dead Band Value Universal Input Channel 1
13 Nu
14 EC Nu EA AL EI EO Open Circuit ChI 2 0V Adj Filter Setting ChI2
15 Wire & CLCD TU ChI1 Nu Inpt Dta Fm ChI2 Nu Inpt Tp/RngeSel ChI2
16 S Process Alarm High Data Value Universal Input Channel 2
17 S Process Alarm Low Data Value Universal Input Channel 2

164 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller Embedded Analog I/O Module Configuration Image Array (Continued)
Bit
Word
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
18 S Alarm Dead Band Value Universal Input Channel 2
19 Nu
20 EC Nu EA AL EI EO Open Circuit ChI 3 0V Adj Filter Setting ChI3
21 Nu TU ChI1 Nu Inpt Dta Fm ChI3 Nu Inpt Tp/RngeSel ChI3
22 S Process Alarm High Data Value Universal Input Channel 3
23 S Process Alarm Low Data Value Universal Input Channel 3
24 S Alarm Dead Band Value Universal Input Channel 3
25 Nu
26 CJC Ses Cycle Nu CJC WP Nu TU CJC
Calib
27 Nu
28 EC NU EHI ELI LC ER FM PM Nu PFE
29 Nu Outpt Fm ChI0 Nu Outpt Tp/RngeSel Ch0
30 S Fault Value Channel 0
31 S Program (Idle) Value Channel 0
32 S Clamp High Data Value Channel 0
33 S Clamp Low Data Value Channel 0
34 S Ramp Rate Channel 0
35 Nu
36 EC Nu EHI ELI LC ER FM PM Nu PFE
37 Nu Outpt Fm ChI1 Nu Outpt Tp/RngeSel ChI1
38 S Fault Value Channel 1
39 S Program (Idle) Value Channel 1
40 S Clamp High Data Value Channel 1
41 S Clamp Low Data Value Channel 1
42 S Ramp Rate Channel 1

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 165


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller Embedded Analog I/O Module Configuration Image Array (Continued)
Bit
Word
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Use to enable or disable a channel. Each channel can be individually enabled.
EC 0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Inpt Dta Use this bit to select the form in which the analog data is returned to the controller and used in the control program.
FM CHIx
Use this bit to enable or disable the process alarms of a channel.
EA 0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Use this bit to enable or disable alarm latching on the process alarm of a channel.
AL 0 = No latch
1 = Latch
Use this bit to enable or disable interrupts on the process alarms of a channel.
EI 0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Use this bit to enable or disable Open Circuit functionality on a channel.
EO 0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Use to set the Open Circuit Response for a channel.
Where: Open 0 = Upscale
Circuit 1 = Downscale
Chx 2 = Last State
3 = Zero
CJC is performed by default by taking the CJC sensor temperature value for a given channel, converting that to a thermocouple voltage, and adding
OV that voltage from the measured value before converting to a user value. If this bit is set for a given channel, the signal value is directly converted
adjust to a user value (No cold junction compensation performed).
Use to set the wire mode. The combination of values in bits 14 and 15 determine the mode, as listed in the following table.

Table 1 -
Wire & Bit 15 Value Bit 14 Value Mode
CLCD
0 0 3-wire and cycle lead compensation - Enable
0 1 3-wire and cycle lead compensation - Disable
1 0 2-wire (No lead compensation)
1 1 4 i (N l d ti )
Use to set the temperature units.
TU Chx 0 = Degrees Celsius
1 = Degrees Fahrenheit

166 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller Embedded Analog I/O Module Configuration Image Array (Continued)
Bit
Word
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Use these bits to select the form the analog input data is presented to the controller and used by the controller. The combination of multiple
Inpt Dta selections in words and bits determines this value.
Fm ChIx For more information on what selections determine the input data form that is used, see the Analog Input Data Format table on page 169.
Inpt Tp / Use these bits to select the input type and operating range for a channel. For more information on what selections determine the input type and
Rnge Sel operating range for a channel, see the Analog Input Type and Operating Range table on page 170.
ChIx
Filter
Setting Use these bits to select the filter setting for a channel. For more information on what selections determine the filter settings for a channel, see the
Input Filter Selections table on page 169.
Chx
Process
Alarm
High
Data Use to configure the Process Alarm High value for a channel. Configuration is done by using words 4, 10, 16, and 22 to set the Alarm High value.
Value
Channel
x
Process
Alarm
Low
Data Use to configure the Process Alarm Low value for a channel. Configuration is done by using words 5, 11, 17, and 23 to set the Low High value.
Value
Channel
x
Alarm
Dead
Where Band
(cont.) Data Use to configure the Alarm Deadband value for a channel. Configuration is done by using words 6, 12, 18, and 24 to set the deadband alarm value.
Value
Channel
x
Use to enable or disable the timestamping function on the module.
ETS 0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Real
Time Use to set the Real Time Sample value. The available range = 0…5000 ms.
Stamp
Value
Use this bit to enable or disable a CJC sensor.
UpdateC • If enabled, the CJC is read once every other module scan, and its value is updated in the CJC status word. This value is also used for
JCComp thermocouple cold junction compensation.
ensatio • If disabled, the CJC sensor value isn’t acquired, and the CJC temperature is fixed at 25 °C (77 °F) for all channels. The CJC is also fixed at 25 °C
nEn (77 °F) for all channels if it’s determined to be broken (short or open circuit).
0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Use this bit to enable Cycle Calibration.
• If enabled, the internal calibration of the module occurs once every 5 minutes.
Cycle • If disabled, the internal calibration of the module occurs only once at power on/ reset.
Calib Cycle Calibration enables the module to readjust for environmental changes such as variations in temperature. However, the module throughput is
slightly reduced during the calibration operation.
0 = Disable
1 = Enable

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 167


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controller Embedded Analog I/O Module Configuration Image Array (Continued)
Bit
Word
15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Use this bit to enable or disable the CJC Weighted Profile.
• If enabled, the CJC temperature for each channel is scaled by multiplying the single CJC reading by a predefined scale factor that is derived from
lab measurements of the stable temperature of each terminal block pin. In this condition, all channel data is overridden with the
CJC temperature of that channel.
CJC WP
• If disabled, the single CJC reading is applied directly to all channels. If the CJC sensors are installed in a remote terminal block, the weighted
profile must be disabled. In this condition, channel data is presented in the input table as normal.
0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Use this bit to select whether data from the Program/Idle m ode or the Fault Enable mode is applied.
PFE 0 = Program/Idle mode data applied
1 = Fault mode data applied
Use this bit to enable or disable ramping for each channel.
ER 0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Use this bit to enable or disable the output channel interrupt function when a High Clamp alarm is set.
EHI 0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Use this bit to enable or disable the output channel interrupt function when a Low Clamp alarm is set.
ELI 0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Use this bit to set data a channel uses when it is in Program/Idle mode.
Where PM 0 = Hold Last State value
(cont.) 1 = User-defined value
Use this bit to set the data a channel uses when it is in Fault mode.
FM 0 = Hold Last State value
1 = User-defined value
Use this bit to enable or disable latch functionality when Low/High clamp and Under/Over range alarm conditions exist on a channel.
LC 0 = Disable
1 = Enable
Outpt Use these bits to select the form the analog output data is presented to the controller and used by the controller. The combination of multiple
Dta Fm selections in words and bits determines this value.
ChIx For more information on what selections determine the output data form that is used, see the Analog Output Data Format table on page 171.
Outpt Tp Use these bits to select the output type and operating range for a channel. For more information on what selections determine the input type and
/ Rnge operating range for a channel, see the Analog Output Type and Operating Range table on page 171.
Sel ChIx
Fault
Value Use this bit to configure the Fault mode value for a channel.
Channel
x
Program
(Idle)
Value Use this bit to configure the Program/Idle mode value for a channel.
Channel
x
ClampHi
gh Data
Value Use this bit to configure the Clamp High data value for a channel.
Channel
x
Clamp
Where Low
(cont.) Data Use this bit to configure the Clamp Low data value for a channel.
Value
Channel
x
Ramp
Rate Use this bit to set the Ramp Rate value for a channel.
Channel
x

168 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Input Filter Selections

This table lists the bit value combinations that you can use to select a filter setting for a
channel. You use bits 0…3 in words 2, 8, 14, and 20 to make this selection.
Input Filter Selections
Bit Settings
Filter Value (Words 3, 9, 15, and 21)
Bit 03 Bit 02 Bit 01 Bit 00
60 Hz 0 0 0 0
50 Hz 0 0 0 1
10 Hz 0 0 1
250 Hz 0 0 1 1
500 Hz 0 1 0 0
1 kHz 0 1 0 1
Spare(1) Values 6...15
(1) An attempt to write a non-valid (any Spare value) or Not Used bit configuration into the Input Filter Response Select field
causes a Module Configuration Error (contained in the Mod_Condition Array).

Analog Input Data Format

This table lists the bit value combinations that you can use to select the output data format for
analog data that is sent to the controller for a channel. You use bits 8…10 in words 3, 9, 15, and 21 to
make this selection.
Analog Input Data Format
Bit Settings
Analog Output Data Format (Words 3, 9, 15, and 21)
Bit 10 Bit 09 Bit 08
Raw/Proportional Data 0 0 0
Engineering Units 0 0 1
Engineering Units x 10 0 1 0
Scaled for PID 0 1 1
Percent Range 1 0 0
Spare(1) Values 5...7
(1) An attempt to write a non-valid (any Spare value) bit configuration into the Input/Output Data Format Select field causes a
Module Configuration Error (contained in Mod_Condition Array). All bits shown as 0 in this table are set to 0.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 169


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Analog Input Type and Operating Range

This table lists the bit value combinations that you can use to select the input type and
operating range for a channel. You use bits 0…5 in words 3, 9, 15, 21, 29, and 37 to make the
selections.
Analog Input Type and Operating Range
Bit Settings
Input Type and Normal Operating Range (Words 3, 9, 15, and 21)
Bit 05 Bit 04 Bit 03 Bit 02 Bit Bit 00
-10…10V DC 0 0 0 0 0 0
0…5V DC 0 0 0 0 0 1
0…10V DC 0 0 0 0 1 0
4…20 mA 0 0 0 0 1 1
1…5V DC 0 0 0 1 0 0
0…20 mA 0 0 0 1 0 1
-50 mV…50 mv 0 0 0 1 1 0
-100…+100 mV 0 0 0 1 1 1
Thermocouple J 0 0 1 0 0 0
Thermocouple K 0 0 1 0 0 1
Thermocouple T 0 0 1 0 1 0
Thermocouple E 0 0 1 0 1 1
Thermocouple R 0 0 1 1 0 0
Thermocouple S 0 0 1 1 0 1
Thermocouple B 0 0 1 1 1 0
Thermocouple N 0 0 1 1 1 1
Thermocouple C 0 1 0 0 0 0
100  PT 385 0 1 0 0 0 1
200  PT 385 0 1 0 0 1 0
500  PT 385 0 1 0 0 1 1
1000  PT 385 0 1 0 1 0 0
100  PT 3916 0 1 0 1 0 1
200  PT 3916 0 1 0 1 1 0
500  PT 3916 0 1 0 1 1 1
1000  PT 3916 0 1 1 0 0 0
10  CU 426 0 1 1 0 0 1
120  Ni 618 0 1 1 0 1 0
120  Ni 672 0 1 1 0 1 1
604  NiFe 518 0 1 1 1 0 0
150  0 1 1 1 0 1
500  0 1 1 1 1 0
1000  0 1 1 1 1 1
3000  1 0 0 0 0 0

170 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Analog Output Data Format

This table lists the bit value combinations that you can use to select the output data format for
analog data that is sent to the controller for a channel. You use bits 8…10 in words 29 and 37 to
make this selection.
Analog Output Data Format
Bit Settings
Analog Output Data Format (Words 29 and 37)
Bit 10 Bit 09 Bit 08
Raw/Proportional Data 0 0 0
Engineering Units 0 0 1
Scaled for PID 0 1 0
Percent Range 0 1 1
Spare(1) Values 4…7
(1) An attempt to write a non-valid (any Spare value) bit configuration into the Input/Output Data Format Select field causes a
Module Configuration Error (contained in Mod_Condition Array). All bits shown as 0 in this table are set to 0.

Analog Output Type and Operating Range

This table lists the bit value combinations that you can use to select the input type and
operating range for a channel. You use bits 0…5 in words 29 and 37 to make the selections.
Analog Output Type and Operating Range
Bit Settings
Output Type and Normal (Words 29 and 37)
Operating Range
Bit 05 Bit 04 Bit 03 Bit 02 Bit Bit 00
-10…10V DC 0 0 0 0 0 0
0…5V DC 0 0 0 0 0 1
0…10V DC 0 0 0 0 1 0
4…20 mA 0 0 0 0 1 1
1…5V DC 0 0 0 1 0 0
0…20 mA 0 0 0 1 0 1

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 171


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Local Expansion Modules - Optional


CompactLogix 5370 L2 control systems support the use of Compact I/O™ modules as local
expansion modules along a CompactBus backplane:
• The controllers support as many as four Compact I/O modules as local expansion
modules.
• When possible, use specialty Compact I/O modules to meet unique application
requirements.
• Consider using a 1492 wiring system for each I/O module as an alternative to the
terminal block that comes with the module.
• Use 1492 PanelConnect™ modules and cables if you’re connecting input modules to
sensors.
• Install local expansion modules in the same local bank as the CompactLogix 5370 L2
controller.

Install Local Expansion Modules

Complete these steps to install local expansion modules in your CompactLogix 5370 L2 control
system.
1. Attach the Compact I/O modules as described in these publications:
• Compact I/O Modules Installation Instructions, publication 1769-IN088
• Compact I/O DeviceNet® Scanner Module Installation Instructions, publication
1769-IN060
2. Use the tongue-and-groove slots to attach a 1769-ECR Compact I/O end cap terminator
to the last module in the system.
3. Move the lever of the end cap bus terminator fully to the left until it clicks to lock the
end cap bus terminator.

Wire Local Expansion Modules

Wire each Compact I/O module that is used as a local expansion module according to the
technical documentation for that module.

172 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Distributed I/O Modules over an EtherNet/IP Network


You can include distributed I/O modules over an EtherNet/IP™ network in your CompactLogix
5370 L2 control system.

Consider these points when using distributed I/O modules over an


EtherNet/IP network:
• Each remote EtherNet/IP adapter included in the system must be counted toward the
maximum number of EtherNet/IP nodes of the controller.
For more information on maximum number of EtherNet/IP nodes, see Chapter 6,
page 102.
• The configurable RPI settings vary depending on which distributed I/O modules are
used in the system.
• For information to add distributed I/O modules to your CompactLogix 5370 L2 control
system, see page 185.

The following graphic shows a CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system on an EtherNet/IP


network that uses all three I/O module options.
Embedded I/O Modules Local Expansion Modules

Distributed I/O Modules

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 173


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Distributed I/O Modules over a DeviceNet Network


You can include distributed I/O modules over a DeviceNet network in your CompactLogix 5370
L2 control system.

You must use the following to use distributed I/O modules over a DeviceNet network in your
CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system:
• Logix Designer application or the Studio 5000® environment - For more information,
see page 182.
• RSNetWorx™ for DeviceNet software - For more information, see page 185.

The following graphic shows a CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system on a DeviceNet network
that uses all three I/O module options.
Embedded I/O Modules Local Expansion Modules

Distributed I/O Modules

174 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Validate I/O Layout You must validate the layout of I/O modules in your CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system.
Consider the points detailed in this section when validating
I/O layout placement.

Estimate Requested Packet Interval


The requested packet interval (RPI) defines the frequency at which the controller sends data
to and receives data from I/O modules. You set an RPI rate for each I/O module in your system,
including embedded I/O modules, local expansion modules, or distributed I/O modules over an
EtherNet/IP network.

The CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers attempt to scan an I/O module at the configured RPI
rate. The controller scans distributed I/O modules at the configured RPI rates.

With embedded I/O modules and local expansion modules, however, some system
configuration parameters determine the actual rate at which the controller scans the
modules. That is, the controller can be configured to scan an I/O module at one rate but
actually scan the module at another rate.

For individual I/O modules, a module RPI overlap minor fault (further described on page 176)
occurs if there is at least one I/O module that can’t be serviced within its RPI time.

The configuration parameters for a system determine the impact on actual RPI rates. These
configuration factors can affect the effective scan frequency for any individual embedded or
local expansion module:
• Rates at which RPI values are set for embedded I/O modules
• Number of embedded I/O modules that are used in the system
• Types of embedded I/O modules that are used in the system
• Rates at which RPI values are set for Compact I/O modules
• Number of Compact I/O modules in the system
• Types of Compact I/O modules in the system
• Application user task priorities
Requested Packet Interval Rate Guidelines
Type of Module Guidelines(1)
The following guidelines apply:
• 1…2 modules can be scanned in 0.5 ms.
All digital
• 3…4 modules can be scanned in 1 ms.
• 5…30 modules can be scanned in 2 ms.
The following guidelines apply:
Mix of digital • 1…2 modules can be scanned in 0.5 ms.
and analog or all • 3…4 modules can be scanned in 1 ms.
analog • 5…13 modules can be scanned in 2 ms.
• 14…30 modules can be scanned in 3 ms.
The following conditions apply:
• For every 1769-SDN module in the system, increase every RPI by 2 ms for every other module.
Specialty • For every 1769-HSC module in the system, increase every RPI by 1 ms for every other module.
• For every 1769-ASCII module in the system, increase every RPI by 1 ms for every other module.
• For every 1769-SM2 module in the system, increase every RPI by 2 ms for every other module.
(1) The guidelines in this table do not factor in the following items, which affect the CMX5370 controller CPU loading:
I/O RPI timing does not affect the task priority. Event and periodic tasks have higher priority than I/O and user tasks.
IOT (Immediate Output Instruction) Messaging CompactBus browsing such as accessing DeviceNet network through 1769-SDN
using CMX5370 Ethernet or USB connection. Module RPI guidelines can require adjustment (increase of 1 ms or more) if the
CMX5370 controller application includes one or more of the listings in this table. Monitor controller minor faults to determine
if Module RPI overlaps have occurred.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 175


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

IMPORTANT When considering the number of I/O modules, remember that they can
be the embedded I/O modules on the controller or Compact I/O
modules that are used as local expansion modules.
Therefore, the consideration for using modules can be any of the
following system configurations:
• Only embedded I/O modules
• Only Compact I/O modules
• Some combination of embedded I/O modules and Compact I/O modules
You can set the RPI rates higher for individual Compact I/O modules. The RPI shows how
quickly modules can be scanned, not how quickly an application can use the data. The RPI is
asynchronous to the program scan. Other factors, such as program execution duration, affect
I/O throughput.

Module Fault Related to RPI Estimates


When following the RPI rate guidelines, most CompactLogix 5370 L2 control systems operate
as expected. Some systems that follow the guidelines can experience a Module RPI Overlap
minor fault that is described in this table.
Name Fault Information Condition in Which Fault Occurs
This fault is logged when the current RPI update of an I/O module overlaps with
its previous RPI update. The Minor Faults tab in the Controller Properties dialog
box indicates in which module the RPI overlap occurs.
If multiple I/O modules experience the fault, the application indicates that the
fault occurred on the first such I/O module. Typically, it’s an I/O module with
large Input/Output array sizes. Example modules that use large Input/Output
array sizes include the 1769-SDN and 1769-HSC modules. In these cases, we
(Type 03) I/O fault recommend that you adjust the RPI of the module to eliminate the fault.
(Code 94) Module Once the fault is cleared from the first I/O module, the application indicates the
RPI overlap next module that experiences the fault. This pattern continues until the fault is
detected cleared from all affected I/O modules.
Module RPI Module Slot = x, To avoid this fault, set the RPI rate of the I/O modules to higher numerical
Overlap where x is the slot values. We recommend that you use an RPI value that is not a common multiple
number of the I/O of other module RPI values, such as 2.5 ms, 5.5 ms, or 7 ms:
module in the I/O • We recommend that you do not run CompactLogix 5370 L2 control systems
Configuration with Module RPI Overlap faults.
section
• A system that experiences many Module RPI Overlap faults can’t operate
optimally because I/O data isn’t sampled at the expected rate that RPI settings
determine.
• When the project is downloaded or the RPI value of a module is adjusted, it’s
expected to have a minor fault. Faults under these conditions are
transitionary. Clear the fault and wait for the fault to reappear before
adjusting the RPI value or the task priorities.

System Power Availability


An embedded 24V DC Input, nonisolated power supply powers all components in a
CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system.

The embedded power supply provides the following power to the CompactBus:
• 1769-L24ER-QB1B controller:
- 1.54 A @ 5V DC
- 0.95 A @ 24V DC
• 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B, 1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK, and 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers:
- 1 A @ 5V DC
- 0.8 A @ 24V DC
The embedded power supply can power any combination of controller, embedded I/O modules,
and local expansion modules that are used in your application.

176 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Power Supply Distance Rating


In a CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system, you can install Compact I/O modules on as local
expansion modules to the right of the controller system. Compact I/O modules each have a
power supply distance rating that you must consider before you install them.

Power supply distance rating is the number of slots a Compact I/O module can be installed
away from the power supply. If a Compact I/O module has a distance rating of three, you can
include up to two modules between the Compact I/O module and the power supply.

Additionally, the controller has embedded I/O modules that are designed to protect against
installation of a Compact I/O module directly to the right of the embedded power supply.
CompactLogix 5370 L2 control systems have embedded I/O modules in the controller.
CompactLogix 5370 L2 control systems have one or two embedded I/O modules as described
as follows:
• 1769-L24ER-QB1B controller - one embedded I/O module
• 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B, 1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK, and 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controllers - two
embedded I/O modules

The embedded I/O modules aren’t considered local expansion modules. However, you must still
include each embedded I/O module in the module slot count when determining where to install
Compact I/O module as a local expansion module.

Because CompactLogix 5370 L2 control systems only allow up to four local expansion modules
in the system, you can install most Compact I/O modules in any local expansion module slot.
Some Compact I/O modules have power supply distance ratings that affect where you can
install them in the CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system.

For example, the 1769-ASCII Compact ASCII and 1769-HSC Compact high-speed counter
modules each have a power supply distance rating of four. The farthest local expansion
module slot where you can install one of these modules in a CompactLogix 5370 L2 control
system is module slot number two or three. The controller catalog number that is used in the
control system determines the slot number.

This table describes the farthest local expansion module slot where you can install a 1769-HSC
high-speed counter module and meet its power supply distance rating requirement.
Example CompactLogix 5370 L2 Control Systems with a 1769-HSC High-speed Counter Module
Number of Embedded 1769-HSC High-speed Counter Module Power Supply Distance Rating Calculation Impact
Controller Cat. No. I/O Modules
The embedded I/O module is the first module in the module count. At its maximum power supply distance rating, the
1769-HSC high-speed counter module can be installed in slot 3 of the local expansion modules, as shown in this graphic.

1769-HSC Module
1769-L24ER-QB1B 1

Three modules between the power supply and the 1769-HSC high-speed counter module. With this controller catalog number, you can
only install up to two local expansion modules between the controller and the 1769-HSC high-speed counter module.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 177


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Example CompactLogix 5370 L2 Control Systems with a 1769-HSC High-speed Counter Module (Continued)
Number of Embedded 1769-HSC High-speed Counter Module Power Supply Distance Rating Calculation Impact
Controller Cat. No. I/O Modules
The embedded I/O modules are the first two modules in the module count. At its maximum power supply distance rating,
the 1769-HSC high-speed counter module can be installed in slot 2 of the local expansion modules, as shown here.

1769-HSC High-speed
Module

Three modules between the power supply and the 1769-HSC high-speed counter module. With this controller catalog number, you can
only install one local expansion module between the controller and the 1769-HSC high-speed counter.

IMPORTANT When counting I/O modules to determine the 1769-HSC high-speed counter
module placement in a 1769-L24ER-QBFC1B or 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B control
1769-L24ER-QBFC1B, system, the embedded I/O module appearance is different between the
1769-L24ER-QBFC1BK, 2 physical appearance and the appearance of the module in the application.
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B The physical appearance is a shown in the previous graphic. The second
module is two rows of termination points below one set of status indicators.
In the application Controller Organizer, the second embedded I/O module
appears as two modules, each with their own slot number, [2] and [3].
When the 1769-HSC high-speed counter module is installed in the farthest
local expansion module slot possible, that is the fourth module in the
system, it appears with a [5] designation in the Controller Organizer, as
shown in this graphic.

Modules [2] and [3] are


shown separately but are
considered one module
when counting modules
to meet power supply
distance rating
requirements.

1769-HSC high-speed counter module is shown as module [5] in this location but considered the
fourth module when counting modules to meet power supply distance rating requirements.

For more information about the power supply distance rating for a Compact
I/O module, see CompactLogix Selection Guide, publication 1769-SG001.

178 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Configure Local I/O Modules You can configure one of these types of local I/O modules in the programming software
environment:

Configure Embedded I/O Modules


Embedded I/O modules are automatically created in the I/O Configuration portion of the
Controller Organizer. Complete these steps to configure an embedded I/O module in your
CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system.
1. Right-click the embedded I/O module and select Properties.

2. Select the required tab, make the necessary changes, and select OK.

IMPORTANT You can also use the tags to configure the embedded I/O modules of
the CompactLogix 5370 L2 controller. When attempting to use the tags
to make analog I/O module selections in the input, output, and
configuration data arrays, the options are complicated.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 179


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Configure Local Expansion Modules


Complete these steps to add a Compact I/O module to your CompactLogix 5370 L2 control
system and configure it.
1. Right-click the 1769 Bus and select New Module.

2. Select the desired I/O module and select Create.

The New Module dialog box appears.


3. Configure the new I/O module as necessary and select OK.

180 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Common Configuration Parameters


While the configuration options vary from module to module, there are some common options
you typically configure when using Compact I/O modules in a CompactLogix 5370 L2 control
system, as described in this table.
Common Configuration Parameters
Configuration Option Description
The RPI specifies the interval at which data is transmitted or received over a connection. For 1769 Compact Local I/O modules, data
is transmitted to the controller at the RPI.
When scanned on the local bus or over an EtherNet/IP network, input modules are scanned at the RPI specified in the module
configuration. Typically, you configure an RPI in milliseconds (ms). For I/O modules, the range is 0.5…750 ms.
Requested packet interval (RPI) When scanned over a DeviceNet network via a 1769-SDN scanner in the CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system, distributed input
modules are scanned at the rate the DeviceNet adapter that connects the input modules to the network supports. For example, if
your system includes a remote system of 1734 POINT I/O™ modules on a DeviceNet network, the 1769-SDN scanner can only scan
the distributed 1734 POINT I/O modules as quickly as the 1734-ADN DeviceNet adapter can transmit the data.
Set of configuration parameters that affect data transmission between the controller and the I/O module. The parameters include
the following:
• Series - Hardware series of the module.
• Revision - Major and minor firmware revision levels that are used on the module.
Module definition
• Electronic Keying - See LOGIX-AT001 for Electronic Keying information.
• Connection - Type of connection between the controller writing the configuration and the I/O module, such as Output.
• Data format - Type of data that is transferred between the controller and I/O module and what tags are generated when the
configuration is complete.
This option determines how the controller is affected if the connection to an I/O module fails in Run mode. You can configure the
Module Fault on Controller If project so that a connection failure causes a major fault on the controller or not.
Connection Fails While in Run Mode The default setting is for the option to be enabled, that is, if the connection to an I/O module fails in Run mode, a major fault occurs
on the controller.

I/O Connections

IMPORTANT You can only use direct connections with the local expansion modules in
a CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system.
A Logix 5000™ system uses connections to transmit I/O data, as described in this table.
I/O Module Connections
Connection Description
A direct connection is a real-time, data-transfer link between the controller and an I/O module. The controller maintains and
monitors the connection. Any break in the connection, such as a module fault, causes the controller to set fault status bits in the
Direct data area that is associated with the module.
Typically, analog I/O modules, diagnostic I/O modules, and specialty modules require direct connections.
For digital I/O modules, you can select rack-optimized communication.
This option is used with distributed I/O modules and the Rack Optimization connection selection is made when configuring the
remote adapter. For example, if your CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system includes distributed digital I/O modules over an
EtherNet/IP and you want to use a rack-optimized connection with those digital I/O modules, you must configure the EtherNet/IP
Rack-optimized adapter of the distributed digital I/O modules to use a connection type of Rack Optimization.
A rack-optimized connection consolidates connection usage between the controller and the digital I/O modules in a remote chassis
or on one DIN rail. Rather than having individual, direct connections for each I/O module, there’s one connection for the entire rack
(or DIN rail).

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 181


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Configure Distributed I/O Your CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system can use distributed I/O modules on an EtherNet/IP
network.
Modules on an EtherNet/IP
Network IMPORTANT When adding distributed I/O modules, remember to count the remote
Ethernet adapter to remain within the maximum number of EtherNet/IP
network nodes limitation for your controller.
The distributed I/O modules that are connected to the controller via the
remote Ethernet adapter aren’t counted toward the maximum Ethernet
node limit for the controller.
For example, a 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controller supports up to 16
Ethernet nodes. You can add up to 16 remote Ethernet adapters to the I/
O Configuration section because each remote adapter counts against
the node count. However, you can add as many remote I/O modules to
the chassis of the adapter as necessary. Remote I/O modules do not
count against the node count.
For more information on node limitations, see Chapter 6, page 102.
Complete these steps to configure distributed I/O modules on an EtherNet/IP network.
1. Right-click Ethernet and select New Module.

2. Select the desired Ethernet adapter and select Create.

The New Module dialog box appears.

182 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

3. Configure the new Ethernet adapter as necessary and select OK.

4. Right-click the new adapter and select New Module.

5. Select the desired I/O module and select Create.

The New Module dialog box appears.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 183


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

6. Configure the new I/O module as necessary and select OK.

7. Repeat these steps to add all desired distributed I/O modules.

This graphic is an example of a 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B control system that uses distributed I/O
modules over an EtherNet/IP network.
1794-AENTR FLEX™ I/O 1734-AENTR POINT I/O

PanelView™ Plus

1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B • Kinetix 350 • Kinetix® 350


• 1783-ETAP EtherNet/IP Tap • 1783-ETAP EtherNet/IP Tap

184 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Configure Distributed I/O Your CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system can use distributed I/O modules on a DeviceNet
network.
Modules on a DeviceNet
Network Complete these steps to configure distributed I/O modules on a DeviceNet network.
1. If you haven’t done so, install a 1769-SDN Compact I/O DeviceNet scanner into the local
bank of your CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system.
2. Right-click 1769 Bus and select New Module.

3. Select the 1769-SDN scanner and select Create.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 185


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

4. Select a Major Revision and select OK.

The New Module dialog box appears.


5. Configure the new 1769-SDN scanner as necessary and select OK.

6. Use RSNetWorx for DeviceNet software to define the scan list in the 1769-SDN scanner
to communicate data between the devices and the controller through the scanner.

The following graphic is an example of a 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B control system that uses


distributed I/O modules on a DeviceNet network.

• 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B
• 1769-SDN

1734-ADN POINT I/O 1606-XLDNET 1794-ADN FLEX I/O

186 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

Monitor I/O Modules With CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers, you can use the following options to monitor I/O
modules:
• QuickView™ pane below the Controller Organizer
• Connection tab in the Module Properties dialog box
• Programming logic to monitor fault data so you can act.

When a fault occurs on an I/O module, a yellow triangle on the module listing in the Controller
Organizer alerts you to the fault, as shown in this graphic.

This graphic shows the Quick View pane, which indicates the type of fault.

To see the fault description on the Connection tab in Module Properties dialog box, complete
these steps.
1. In the I/O Configuration, right-click the faulted I/O module and select Properties.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 187


Chapter 8 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L2 Controllers

2. Select the Connection tab and use the fault description, in the Module Fault section, to
diagnose the issue.

3. Select OK to close the dialog box and remedy the issue.

End Cap Detection and Module Faults


End cap detection is performed through the last module on a 1769 Bus. If that module
experiences a fault such that it can’t communicate on the 1769 Bus, the following events occur:
• End cap detection fails
• Controller faults

188 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 9

Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370


L3 Controllers

Select I/O Modules This chapter details the I/O module options that CompactLogix™ 5370 L3 control
systems offer.

Local Expansion Modules


CompactLogix 5370 L3 control systems support the use of Compact I/O™ modules as local
expansion modules along a CompactBus backplane.

Consider the following when using local expansion modules:


• The controllers support this many local Compact I/O modules across up to three I/O
banks, that is, the local bank and two more banks.
Cat. No. Maximum Local Expansion Modules Supported
1769- L30ER, 1769-L30ERK
1769-L30ERM, 1769-L30ERMK 8
1769-L30ER-NSE
1769-L33ER, 1769-L33ERK 16
1769-L33ERM, 1769-L33ERMK
1769-L33ERMO —
1769-L36ERM 30
1769-L36ERMO —
1769-L37ERM, 1769-L37ERMK 31
1769-L37ERMO(1) —
1769-L38ERM, 1769-L38ERMK 31
1769-L38ERMO(1) —
(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

• When possible, use specialty Compact I/O modules to meet unique application
requirements.
• Consider using a 1492 wiring system for each I/O module as an alternative to the
terminal block that comes with the module.
• Use 1492 PanelConnect™ modules and cables if you’re connecting input modules to
sensors.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 189


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Install Local Expansion Modules

Complete these steps to install local expansion modules in your CompactLogix 5370 L3 control
system:
1. Attach the 1769 Compact communication or I/O modules as described in these
publications:
• Compact I/O Modules Installation Instructions, publication
1769-IN088
• Compact I/O DeviceNet® Scanner Module Installation Instructions,
publication 1769-IN060
2. If your system uses only a local bank, complete these steps.
a. Use the tongue-and-groove slots to attach a 1769-ECR Compact
I/O end cap terminator to the last module in the system.
b. Move the lever of the end cap bus terminator fully to the left until it clicks to lock the
end cap bus terminator.
3. If your system uses more banks, follow these steps.
a. Install a 1769-CRx Compact I/O communication bus expansion cable at the right end
of the local bank.
b. Connect the 1769-CRx cable to the additional bank as necessary.
How you connect to the first extra bank—on the right or left side of the bank,
determines the expansion cable that is installed at the end of the local bank. See
page 190 for an example of how to connect a local bank to extra banks.
c. Complete the installation of the remaining banks in your system.

IMPORTANT Make sure that you install an end cap at the end of the last bank
in your system.

This figure shows example systems with local expansion modules included.
Figure 6 - Example CompactLogix 5370 L3 Control Systems

Horizontal Orientation

Bank 1 1769-CRLx Cable Bank 2 1769-CRLx Cable Bank 3

Bank 1

1769-CRRx Cable
Vertical Orientation

Bank 2

190 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Wire Local Expansion Modules

Wire each Compact I/O module that is used as a local expansion module according to the
technical documentation for that module.

Distributed I/O Modules over an EtherNet/IP Network


You can include distributed I/O modules over an EtherNet/IP™ network in your CompactLogix
5370 control system. Consider the following when using distributed I/O modules over an
EtherNet/IP network:
• Each remote EtherNet/IP adapter included in the system must be counted toward the
maximum number of EtherNet/IP nodes for the controller.
For more information on the maximum number of EtherNet/IP nodes, see page 102.
• The configurable RPI settings vary depending on which distributed I/O modules are
used in the system.
• For information to add distributed I/O modules to your CompactLogix 5370 control
system, see page 206.
This graphic shows an example 1769-L33ERM control system that uses local expansion
modules and distributed I/O modules over an EtherNet/IP network.

Local Expansion Modules Distributed I/O Modules

Distributed I/O Modules over a DeviceNet Network


You can include distributed I/O modules over a DeviceNet network in your CompactLogix 5370
L3 control system. Consider the following when using distributed I/O modules over a DeviceNet
network:

You must use this software to include distributed I/O modules over a DeviceNet network in
your CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system:
• Logix Designer application or the Studio 5000® environment - for more information, see
page 203.
• RSNetWorx™ for DeviceNet software - for more information, see page 111.

This graphic shows an example 1769-L33ERM control system that uses local expansion
modules and distributed I/O modules over a DeviceNet network.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 191


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Local Expansion Modules Distributed I/O Modules

192 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Validate I/O Layout After you’ve selected your I/O modules, you must validate the system that you want to design.
Consider the points detailed in this section when validating I/O layout placement.

Estimate Requested Packet Interval


The requested packet interval (RPI) defines the frequency at which the controller sends data
to and receives data from I/O modules. You set an RPI rate for each I/O module in your system.

The CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers attempt to scan an I/O module at the configured RPI
rate. For individual I/O modules, a Module RPI Overlap minor fault (further described on
page 194) occurs if there is at least one I/O module that can’t be serviced within its RPI time.
The configuration parameters for a system determine the impact on actual RPI rates. These
configuration factors can affect the effective scan frequency for any individual module:
• Rates at which RPI rates are set for other Compact I/O modules
• Number of other Compact I/O modules in the system
• Types of other Compact I/O modules in the system
• Application user task priorities
Requested Packet Interval Rate Guidelines
Type of Module Guidelines(1)
The following guidelines apply:
• 1…2 modules can be scanned in 0.5 ms.
All digital
• 3…4 modules can be scanned in 1 ms.
• 5…30 modules can be scanned in 2 ms.
The following guidelines apply:
• 1…2 modules can be scanned in 0.5 ms.
Mix of digital and analog or all analog • 3…4 modules can be scanned in 1 ms.
• 5…13 modules can be scanned in 2 ms.
• 14…30 modules can be scanned in 3 ms.
The following conditions apply:
• For every 1769-SDN module in the system, increase the RPI of every other
module by 2 ms.
• For every 1769-HSC module in the system, increase the RPI of every other
Specialty module by 1 ms.
• For every 1769-ASCII module in the system, increase the RPI of every
other module by 1 ms.
• For every 1769-SM2 module in the system, increase the RPI of every other
module by 2 ms.
(1) The guidelines in this table do not factor in the following items, which affect CMX5370 controller CPU loading:
I/O RPI timing does not affect the task priority. Event and periodic tasks have higher priority than I/O and user tasks.
IOT (Immediate Output Instruction). Messaging CompactBus browsing such as accessing DeviceNet network through
1769-SDN by using CMX5370 Ethernet or USB connection. Module RPI guidelines can require adjustment (increase of 1 ms or
more) if CMX5370 controller application includes one or more of the listings in this table. Monitor controller minor faults to
determine if Module RPI overlaps have occurred.

You can set the RPI rates of individual Compact I/O modules higher than the rates listed. The
RPI shows how quickly modules can be scanned, not how quickly an application can use the
data. The RPI is asynchronous to the program scan. Other factors, such as program execution
duration, affect
I/O throughput.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 193


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Module Fault Related to RPI Estimates


When following the RPI rate guidelines, most CompactLogix 5370 L3 control systems operate
as expected. Some systems that follow the guidelines can experience a Module RPI Overlap
minor fault as described in this table.
Fault Related to RPI
Name Fault Information Condition In Which Fault Occurs
This fault is logged when the current RPI update of an I/O module overlaps with
its previous RPI update. The Minor Faults tab in the Controller Properties dialog
box indicates in which module the RPI overlap occurs.
If multiple I/O modules experience the fault, the application indicates that the
fault occurred on the first such I/O module. Typically, it’s an I/O module with
large Input/Output array sizes. Example modules that use large Input/Output
array sizes include the 1769-SDN and 1769-HSC modules. In these cases, we
(Type 03) I/O fault recommend that you adjust the RPI of the module to eliminate the fault.
(Code 94) Module Once the fault is cleared from the first I/O module, the application indicates the
RPI overlap next module that experiences the fault. This pattern continues until the fault is
detected cleared from all affected I/O modules.
Module RPI Module Slot = x, To avoid this fault, set the RPI rate of the I/O modules to higher numerical
Overlap where x is the slot values. We recommend that you use an RPI value that is not a common multiple
number of the I/O of other module RPI values, such as 2.5 ms, 5.5 ms, or 7 ms.
module in the I/O • We recommend that you do not run CompactLogix 5370 L3 control systems
Configuration with Module RPI Overlap faults.
section
• A system that experiences many Module RPI Overlap faults can’t operate
optimally because I/O data isn’t sampled at the expected rate that the RPI
settings determine.
• When the project is downloaded or the RPI value of an I/O module is adjusted,
it’s expected to have a minor fault. Faults under these conditions are
transitionary. Clear the fault and wait for the fault to reappear before
adjusting the RPI value or the task priorities.

Calculate System Power Consumption


The 1769 Compact I/O power supplies provide power to CompactLogix local and more banks.
The provided power is measured in current capacity.
Consider these points when designing your CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system banks:
• 1769 Compact I/O power supplies have two maximum current capacity requirements
that affect how you design and configure one bank.
The following are the maximum current capacity requirements:
- Maximum current capacity for one bank
- Maximum current capacity for each side of the power supply

Current Capacity for Single Bank

Current Capacity for Side of Bank Current Capacity for Side of Bank

194 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

• The maximum current capacity requirements vary by the power supply that is used in
the bank.
Power Supply Cat. No. Max Current Capacity for Single Bank Max Current Capacity for Each Side of Bank(1)
1769-PA2
2 A at 5V DC and 0.8 A at 24V DC 1 A at 5V DC and 0.4 A at 24V DC
1769-PB2
1769-PA4
4 A at 5V DC and 2 A at 24V DC 2 A at 5V DC and 1 A at 24V DC
1769-PB4
(1) Specification for banks with devices on left and right sides of the power supply.

Calculate Power Consumption in Single Bank

IMPORTANT One bank requires the CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers to reside in


the leftmost slot. At minimum, you must calculate the power
consumption of the controller on the left side of the power supply.
If more modules are installed on the left side of the power supply, you
must calculate the power consumption for those modules as well.
If more modules are installed to the right of the power supply, you must
calculate the power consumption for that side separately.

Use this table to calculate power consumption in one bank.


Module Power Consumption Calculation for a Local Bank
Calculated Current =
Side of Power Number of Module Current Requirements (Number of Modules) x (Module Current
Device Cat. No. Requirements)
Supply Modules(1)
at 5V DC (in mA) at 24V DC (in mA) at 5V DC (in mA) at 24V DC (in mA)
1769-L30ER, 1769-L30ERK
1769-L30ERM, 1769-L30ERMK
1769-L30ER-NSE
1769-L33ER, 1769-L33ERK
Left - Required 1 500 225 500 225
1769-L33ERM, 1769-L33ERMK
1769-L36ERM
1769-L37ERM, 1769-L37ERMK
1769-L38ERM, 1769-L38ERMK
I/O Module-specific Up to 3 Module-specific Module-specific
Left - Optional
Total Current Required(2):

I/O Module-specific
IMPORTANT: Insert a separate row in this Up to 8 Module-specific Module-specific
Right calculation for each I/O module.
Total Current Required(2):

Total Current Required for Single Bank if Modules Are Installed on Both Sides of the Power Supply(3):
(1) In the local bank, you can only install up to three modules to the left of the power supply. This limitation is because the CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers have a power supply distance rating
of four and must be within four slots of the Compact I/O power supply. On the right side of the power supply in the local bank and both sides of the power supply in more banks, you can
install up to eight modules. This configuration is possible only if the power supply distance ratings for the modules validate the system design.
(2) This number must not exceed the power supply current capacity for this side of the bank.
(3) This number must not exceed the power supply current capacity for the bank.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 195


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Calculate Power Consumption in an Additional Bank

IMPORTANT In extra banks, you can install I/O modules to the left side, right side, or
both sides of the power supply.

Use this table to calculate power consumption in an extra bank.


Module Power Consumption Calculation for an Additional Bank
Calculated Current =
Side of Power Number of Module Current Requirements (Number of Modules) x (Module Current
Device Cat. No. Requirements)
Supply Modules(1)
at 5V DC (in mA) at 24V DC (in mA) at 5V DC (in mA) at 24V DC (in mA)
Left - Optional in I/O Modules
IMPORTANT: Insert a separate row in this Up to 8 Module-specific Module-specific
an extra bank calculation for each I/O module.
Total Current Required(2):

I/O Modules
Right - Optional in IMPORTANT: Insert a separate row for each Up to 8 Module-specific Module-specific
one bank I/O module.
Total Current Required(2):

Total Current Required for Bank if Modules Are Installed on Both Sides of the Power Supply(3):
(1) You can install up to eight modules in additional banks if the power supply distance ratings for the modules validate the system design.
(2) This number must not exceed the power supply current capacity for this side of the bank.
(3) This number must not exceed the power supply current capacity for the bank.

196 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Physical Placement of I/O Modules


Depending on the controller catalog number, CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers support from 8
to 30 I/O modules. For more information on local expansion module catalog numbers, see
page 189.

Consider these factors when determining the physical placement of the I/O modules:
• You can install I/O modules in local and extra banks.
• You can install I/O modules to the left and right of the power supply.
• When a system requires multiple banks, you can install the additional banks horizontally
or vertically, as shown in this graphic.

Horizontal Orientation

Local Bank Extra Bank Extra Bank

1769-CRL1 Compact I/O Communication


Bus Expansion Cables

Local Bank

1769-CRR1 Compact I/O Communication


Vertical Orientation
Bus Expansion Cables

Extra Bank

• Each I/O module also has a power supply distance rating and maximum current draw.
Considered jointly, distance ratings and current draw determine where I/O modules can
be placed in a bank and what configuration of modules can be installed in the bank.
For more information on power supply distance ratings, see page 69. For more
information on system power consumption, see page 194.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 197


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Local Bank

To validate the local bank design, confirm that the design meets these requirements:
• The controller is the leftmost device in the local bank.
• No more than three modules are installed between the controller and the left side of the
power supply.
• No more than eight modules are installed to the right of the power supply.
• The power consumption of the modules on each side of the power supply does not
exceed the capacity of the power supply for that side.
• The total power consumption by all modules in the bank does not exceed the capacity
of the power supply for the entire bank.
• Modules are installed such that all power supply distance rating and system power
consumption requirements are met.
For example, the 1769-SDN scanner has a power supply distance rating of four. If the
design includes the installation of a 1769-SDN scanner with greater than three modules
between it and the power supply, the design is invalid.

IMPORTANT Make sure that you take power supply distance ratings into
consideration when you design a system. If you install a module that
violates its power supply distance rating specification, the system can
operate normally for a time, but experience operational issues, such as
I/O faults.

This example graphic shows a local bank.


1769 Compact I/O
Power Supply

1769-L33ER Controller End Cap

Compact I/O Modules Compact I/O Modules

198 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Additional Banks

If your application calls for twelve or more I/O modules, at minimum, you must install the
modules in extra banks. The conditions of each application determine the number of extra
banks.

Once the local bank design is validated, you must validate the design for any additional banks.
To validate extra bank designs, confirm that the design meets these requirements:
• Compact I/O communication bus expansion cables are used properly.
Compact I/O expansion cables have the same dimensions as the end caps
regardless of whether they’re installed at the right or left side of the
communication bus.
• No more than eight modules are installed on either side of the power supply.
• The power consumption of the modules on each side of the power supply does not
exceed the capacity of the power supply for that side.
• Modules are installed such that all power supply distance rating requirements are met.
• End caps are installed properly, as shown in the following graphic.
Local Bank

1769-CRRx Cables

Extra Bank

End Cap

Power Supply Distance Rating


CompactLogix 5370 L3 control systems do not have embedded I/O modules. You begin
counting local expansion slots with the first Compact I/O module installed next to the power
supply when determining where to install a
Compact I/O module and meet its power supply distance rating.

In CompactLogix 5370 L3 control systems, you can install Compact I/O modules to the left or
right side of the power supply. You can also use local and extra banks in CompactLogix 5370
L3 control systems, with each allowing the inclusion of Compact I/O modules.

Local Bank

In the local bank, the controller must be the leftmost device in the system and you can only
install up to three modules between the controller and the power supply. Therefore, any
Compact I/O modules that are installed to the left of the power supply in the local bank are in a
module slot that meets the power supply distance rating requirements for the module.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 199


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Additional Banks

CompactLogix 5370 L3 control systems also support the use of extra banks for the local
expansion modules of the system. Every additional bank requires a 1769 Compact I/O power
supply. The bank can be designed with local expansion modules on either side of the power
supply.
Most Compact I/O modules have power supply distance rating values that allow you to install
them in any slot on either side of the power supply in extra banks. Some Compact I/O modules
have power supply distance ratings that affect where you can install them in the
CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system.

For example, the 1769-ASCII Compact ASCII and 1769-HSC Compact high-speed counter
modules each have a power supply distance rating of four. These modules can be installed in
local expansion module slots one through three.
In this case, you must install the 1769-ASCII module and 1769-HSC high-speed counter module
with no more three Compact I/O modules between the module and the power. This
requirement is true regardless of whether the modules are installed to the left or right of the
power supply.

This graphic shows 1769-HSC high-speed counter modules that are installed in a 1769-L36ERM
control system that meet the power supply distance rating of the module.

1769-HSC Module 1769-HSC Module

Local Bank

1769-HSC High-speed Counter Modules Installed in a 1769-L36ERM Control System Meeting


the Power Supply Distance Rating Requirements of the High-speed Counter Module

Extra Bank

1769-HSC Module 1769-HSC Module

IMPORTANT The Module Power Consumption Calculation for an Additional Bank table
on page 196 shows example systems with 1769-HSC high-speed counter
modules in each control system because it has a power supply distance
rating of four and can’t be installed as far from the Compact I/O power
supply. Most Compact I/O modules have power supply distance ratings
that allow you to install them anywhere in the local expansion slots of a
CompactLogix 5370 L2 control system.
For more information about the power supply distance rating for a
Compact I/O module, see CompactLogix Selection Guide, publication
1769-SG001.

200 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Configure I/O Complete these steps to add a Compact I/O module to your CompactLogix 5370 L3 control
system and configure it.
1. Right-click the 1769 Bus and select New Module.

2. Select the desired I/O module and select Create.

The New Module dialog box appears.


3. Configure the new I/O module as necessary and select OK.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 201


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Common Configuration Parameters


While the configuration options vary from module to module, there are some common options
you typically configure when using Compact I/O modules in a CompactLogix 5370 L3 control
system, as described in this table.

Configuration Option Description


The RPI specifies the interval at which data is transmitted or received over a connection. For 1769 Compact Local I/O modules, data
is transmitted to the controller at the RPI.
When scanned on the local bus or over an EtherNet/IP network, input modules are scanned at the RPI specified in the module
Requested packet interval (RPI) configuration. Typically, you configure an RPI in milliseconds (ms). For I/O modules, the range is 0.5…750 ms.
When scanned over a DeviceNet network, distributed input modules are scanned at the rate that the DeviceNet adapter that
connects the input modules to the network supports. For example, the scan rate for distributed 1734 POINT I/O™ over DeviceNet
can only occur as quickly as the 1734-ADN DeviceNet adapter can transmit the data.
Set of configuration parameters that affect data transmission between the controller and the I/O module. The parameters include
the following:
• Series - Hardware series of the module.
• Revision - Major and minor firmware revision levels that are used on the module.
Module definition
• Electronic Keying - See LOGIX-AT001 for Electronic Keying information.
• Connection - Type of connection between the controller writing the configuration and the I/O module, such as Output.
• Data format - Type of data that is transferred between the controller and I/O module and what tags are generated when the
configuration is complete.
This option determines how the controller is affected if the connection to an I/O module fails in Run mode. You can configure the
Module Fault on Controller If project so that a connection failure causes a major fault on the controller or not.
Connection Fails While in Run Mode The default setting is for the option to be enabled, that is, if the connection to an I/O module fails in Run mode, a major fault occurs
on the controller.

I/O Connections
A Logix 5000™ system uses connections to transmit I/O data, as described in this table.

Connection Description
A direct connection is a real-time, data-transfer link between the controller and an I/O module. The controller maintains and
monitors the connection. Any break in the connection, such as a module fault, causes the controller to set fault status bits in the
Direct data area that is associated with the module.
Typically, analog I/O modules, diagnostic I/O modules, and specialty modules require direct connections.
For digital I/O modules, you can select rack-optimized communication.
This option is used with distributed I/O modules and the Rack Optimization connection selection is made when configuring the
remote adapter. For example, if you want to use a rack-optimized connection with digital I/O modules in a remote 1734 POINT I/O
Rack-optimized system, you configure the 1734-AENT(R) module to use a connection type of Rack Optimization.
A rack-optimized connection consolidates connection usage between the controller and the digital I/O modules in a remote chassis
or on one DIN rail. Rather than having individual, direct connections for each I/O module, there’s one connection for the entire rack
(or DIN rail).

202 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Configure Distributed I/O Your CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system can use distributed I/O modules on an EtherNet/IP
network.
Modules on an EtherNet/IP
Network IMPORTANT When adding distributed I/O modules, remember to count the remote
Ethernet adapter to remain within the maximum number of EtherNet/IP
network nodes limitation for your controller.
The remote I/O modules that are connected to the controller via the
Ethernet adapter aren’t counted toward the maximum Ethernet node
limit for the controller.
For more information on node limitations, see Chapter 6, page 102.
Complete these steps to configure distributed I/O modules on an
EtherNet/IP network.
1. Right-click Ethernet and select New Module.

2. Select the desired Ethernet adapter and select Create.

The New Module dialog box appears.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 203


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

3. Configure the new Ethernet adapter as necessary and select OK.

4. Right-click the new adapter and select New Module.

5. Select the desired I/O module and select Create.

The New Module dialog box appears.

204 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

6. Configure the new I/O module as necessary and select OK.

7. To add the desired distributed I/O modules, repeat these steps.

The following graphic is an example of a 1769-L33ERM control system that uses distributed I/O
modules over an EtherNet/IP network.

1734-AENTR POINT I/O 1769-L33ERM

PanelView™ Plus

1794-AENTR FLEX™ I/O 1732E-IB16M12R

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 205


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Configure Distributed I/O Your CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system can use distributed I/O modules on a DeviceNet
network.
Modules on a DeviceNet
Network Complete these steps to configure distributed I/O modules on a DeviceNet network.
1. If you have not done so, install a 1769-SDN Compact I/O DeviceNet scanner into the local
bank of your CompactLogix 5370 L3 control system.
2. Right-click 1769 Bus and select New Module.

3. Select the 1769-SDN scanner and select Create.

4. Select a Major Revision and select OK.

The New Module dialog box appears.


5. Configure the new 1769-SDN scanner as necessary and select OK.

206 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

6. Use RSNetWorx for DeviceNet software to define the scan list in the 1769-SDN scanner
to communicate data between the devices and the controller through the scanner.

The following graphic is an example of a 1769-L33ERM control system that uses distributed I/O
modules on a DeviceNet network.

• 1769-L33ERM
• 1769-SDN Scanner

1734-ADN POINT I/O 1606-XLDNET 1794-ADN FLEX I/O

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 207


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Monitor I/O Modules With CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers, you can monitor I/O modules in the following ways:
• QuickView™ Pane below the Controller Organizer
• Connection tab in the Module Properties dialog box
• Programming logic to monitor fault data so you can act

When a fault occurs on an I/O module, a yellow triangle on the module listing in the Controller
Organizer alerts you to the fault.

This graphic shows the Quick View Pane, which indicates the type of fault.

To see the fault description on the Connection tab in Module Properties dialog box, complete
these steps.
1. In the I/O Configuration, right-click the faulted I/O module and select Properties.

208 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

2. To diagnose the issue, select the Connection tab and use the fault description, in the
Module Fault section.

3. To close the dialog box and remedy the issue, select OK.

End Cap Detection and Module Faults


End cap detection is performed through the last module on a 1769 Bus. If that module
experiences a fault such that it can’t communicate on the 1769 Bus, the following events occur:
• End cap detection fails
• Controller faults

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 209


Chapter 9 Use I/O Modules with CompactLogix 5370 L3 Controllers

Notes:

210 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 10

Develop Applications

Elements of a Control A control application is composed of several elements that require planning for efficient
application execution. This section details the elements of a control application.
Application
Elements of a Control Program

Control Application

Controller Fault Handler

Task 32

Task 1
Configuration

Status

Watchdog
Program 1000

Program 1
Program (Local
Main Routine Tags and
Parameters)
Fault Routine

Other
Routines

Controller (global)
Tags I/O Data System-shared Data

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 211


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Tasks A Logix 5000® controller lets you use multiple tasks to schedule and prioritize the execution of
your programs that are based on criteria. This multitasking allocates the processing time of
the controller among the different operations in your application:
• The controller executes only one task at a time.
• One task can interrupt the execution of another task and take control.
• In any given task, multiple programs can be used. However, only one program executes
at a time.
• You can display tasks in the Controller or Logical Organizer views, as necessary.
Task in a Control Application
Control Application

Controller Fault Handler

Task 32

Task 1 Task 1
Contains the following: Configuration
• Configuration Data
Status
• Status Data
• Watchdog Data Watchdog
• Programs Program 1000

Program 1
Program (Local
Main Routine Tags and
Parameters)
Fault Routine

Other Routines

Controller (global) Tags


I/O Data System-shared Data

212 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Tasks in Application
Controller Logical Organizer

Main Task
(continuous)

Main Task
(continuous)

Task 2
(periodic)
Task 2
(periodic) Task 3
(event)

Task 3
(event)

A task provides scheduling and priority information for a set of one or more programs.
Configure tasks as continuous, periodic, or event by using the Task Properties dialog box.
Configuring the Task Type

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 213


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

This table explains the types of tasks that you can configure.

Task Types and Execution Frequency


Task Type Task Execution Description
The continuous task runs in the background. Any CPU time that is not allocated to other operations (such as motion,
communication, and other tasks) is used to execute the programs in the continuous task:
Continuous Always • The continuous task runs constantly. When the continuous task completes a full scan, it restarts immediately.
• A project does not require a continuous task. If used, there can be only one continuous task.
A periodic task performs a function at an interval:
• Whenever the time for the periodic task expires, the task interrupts any lower priority tasks, executes once, and
returns control to where the previous task left off.
• You can configure the time period from 0.1…2,000,000.00 ms. The default is 10 ms. It’s also controller and
• At a set interval, such as configuration dependent.
every 100 ms • The performance of a periodic task depends on the type of Logix 5000 controller and on the logic in the task.
Periodic • The periodic task processes I/O data for CompactLogix™, FlexLogix™, DriveLogix™, and SoftLogix™ controllers with
• Multiple times in the scan of
your other logic the following considerations:
– For CompactLogix, FlexLogix, and DriveLogix controllers, operates at priority 6
– For SoftLogix controllers, operates at Windows priority 16 (Idle)
– Higher-priority tasks take precedence over the I/O task and can affect processing
– Executes at the fastest RPI that you’ve scheduled for the system
– Executes for as long as it takes to scan the configured I/O modules
An Event task performs a function only when an event (trigger) occurs. The trigger for the Event task can be
the following:
• A consumed tag trigger
• An EVENT instruction
Immediately when an event
Event • An axis trigger
occurs
• A motion event trigger
• Module input data state change
IMPORTANT: With Logix Designer application, version 21.00.00 or later, you can use this trigger with
1756 ControlLogix®, 1789 SoftLogix, and CompactLogix 5370 L1 applications.

The CompactLogix controller supports up to 32 tasks, only one of which can be continuous.
A task can have up to 1000 separate Programs (as described on page 216) per task, each with
its own executable routines and program-scoped tags. Once a task is triggered (activated), all
programs that are assigned to the task execute in the order in which they’re grouped. Multiple
tasks can’t share Programs and Programs appear only once in the Controller Organizer.

214 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Task Priority
Each task in the controller has a priority level. The operating system uses the priority level to
determine which task to execute when multiple tasks are triggered. A higher priority task
interrupts any lower priority task. A periodic or event task interrupts the continuous task,
which has the lowest priority.
You can configure periodic tasks to execute from the lowest priority of 15 up to the highest
priority of 1. Configure the task priority by using the Task Properties dialog box.
Configure the Task Priority

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 215


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Programs The controller operating system is a pre-emptive multitasking system that is in compliance
with IEC 1131-3. This system provides the following:
• Programs to group data and logic
• Routines to encapsulate executable code that is written in one programming language

Each program contains the following:


• Local Tags
• Parameters
• A main executable routine
• Other routines
• An optional fault routine
Program in a Control Application
Control Application

Controller Fault Handler

Task 32

Task 1
Configuration

Status

Watchdog
Program 1000

Program 1
Program 1 Program (Local
Contains the following: Tags and
Main Routine
• Main Routine Parameters)
• Fault Routine
• Other Routines Fault Routine
• Program Tags

Other Routines

Controller (global) Tags I/O Data System-shared Data

Programs in Application
Controller Organizer Logical Organizer

Program
Program

Program

Program

216 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Scheduled and Unscheduled Programs


The scheduled programs in a task execute to completion from first to last. Programs that
aren’t attached to any task show up as unscheduled programs.

Unscheduled programs in a task are downloaded to the controller with the entire project. The
controller verifies unscheduled programs but does not execute them.

You must schedule a program in a task before the controller can scan the program. To
schedule an unscheduled program, use the Program/Phase Schedule tab of the Task
Properties dialog box.
Scheduling an Unscheduled Program

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 217


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Routines A routine is a set of logic instructions in one programming language, such as Ladder Diagram
(ladder logic). Routines provide the executable code for the project in a controller. A routine is
similar to a program file or subroutine in a PLC or SLC™ processor.

Each program has a main routine. This routine is the first routine to execute when the
controller triggers the associated task and calls the associated program. Use logic, such as
the Jump to Subroutine (JSR) instruction, to call other routines.

You can also specify an optional program fault routine. The controller executes this routine if
it encounters an instruction-execution fault in any of the routines in the associated program.
Routines in a Control Application
Control Application

Controller Fault Handler

Task 32

Task 1
Configuration

Status

Watchdog
Program 1000

Program 1
Program (Local
Main Routine Tags and
Parameters)
Fault Routine

Other Routines

Controller (global) Tags


I/O Data System-shared Data

Routines in Application

Controller Designer Logical Designer

Routine
Routine

Routine
Routine

218 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Tags With a Logix 5000 controller, you use a tag (alphanumeric name) to address data (variables). In
Logix 5000 controllers, there’s no fixed, numeric format. For example, as shown in the
following figure, you can use the tag name north_tank_mix instead of a numeric format, such
as N7:0.0.
The tag name itself identifies the data. The tag lets you do the following:
• Organize your data to mirror your machinery.
• Document your application as you develop it.

This example shows data tags that are created in the scope of the Main Program of the
controller.
Tags Example
Controller Organizer - Main Program Parameters and Local Tags

Program Tags Window - Main Program Tags

Analog I/O Device

Integer Value
Storage Bit
Counter
Timer
Digital I/O Device

There are several guidelines to create and configure parameters and local tags for optimal
task and program execution. For more information, see the Logix 5000 Controllers and I/O Tag
Data Programming Manual,
publication 1756-PM004.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 219


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Extended Properties
The Extended Properties feature lets you define more information, such as limits, engineering
units, or state identifiers, for various components within your controller project.
Component Extended Properties
Tag In the Tag Editor, add extended properties to a tag.
User-defined data type In the Data Type Editor, add extended properties to data types.
In the properties that are associated with the Add-On Instruction definition, add
Add-On Instructions extended properties to Add-On Instructions.

Pass-through behavior is the ability to assign extended properties at a higher level of a


structure or Add-On Instruction and have that extended property automatically available for all
members. Pass-through behavior is available for descriptions, state identifiers, and
engineering units and you can configure it. Configure pass-through behavior on the Project
tab of the Controller Properties dialog box. If you select not to show pass-through properties,
only extended properties that have been configured for a given component are displayed.

Pass-through behavior isn’t available for limits. When an instance of a tag is created, if limits
are associated with the data type, the instance is copied.

You must know which tags have limits that are associated with them as there’s no indication
in the tag browser that extended properties are defined for a tag. If, however, you try to use
extended properties that haven’t been defined for a tag, the editors show a visual indication
and the routine does not verify.

Access Extended Properties in Logic


You can access limits that are defined on tags by using the .@Min and .@Max syntax:
• You can’t write to extended properties values in logic.
• To use extended tag properties in an Add-On Instruction, you must pass them in as
input operands to the Add-On Instruction.
• Alias tags that have extended properties can’t access the extended properties in logic.
• Limits can be configured for input and output parameters in Add-On Instructions.
However, limits can’t be defined on an InOut parameter of an Add-On Instruction.
• Limits can’t be accessed inside Add-On Instruction logic. Limits are for use only by HMI
applications.

If an array tag is using indirect addressing to access limits in logic, these conditions apply:
• If the array tag has limits that are configured, the extended properties are applied to
any array element that does not explicitly have that particular extended property
configured. For example, if the array tag MyArray has Max configured to 100, any
element of the array that does not have Max configured inherits the value of 100 when
being used in logic. However, it isn’t visible that the value inherited from MyArray is
configured in the tag properties.
• At least one array element must have a limit that is configured for indirectly referenced
array logic to verify. For example, if MyArray[x].@Max is being used in logic, at least one
array element of MyArray[] must have Max extended property that is configured if
MyArray hasn’t configured Max.
• Under the following circumstances, a data type default value is used:
- Array is accessed programmatically with indirect reference.
- Array tag does not have the extended property configured.
- A member of an array does not have the extended property configured.
For example, for an array of SINT type, when max limit is called in logic for a member,
use the value of 127. If an array element is directly accessed, the element has to have
the extended property defined. If not, verification fails.

220 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Programming Languages The CompactLogix controller supports these programming languages, online, and offline.
CompactLogix Controller Programming Languages
Language Is best-used in programs with
Continuous or parallel execution of multiple operations (not sequenced)
Boolean or bit-based operations
Complex logical operations
Relay ladder Message and communication processing
Machine interlocking
Operations that service or maintenance personnel can have to interpret to
troubleshoot the machine or process
Continuous process and drive control
Function block diagram Loop control
Calculations in circuit flow
High-level management of multiple operations
Repetitive sequence of operations
Sequential function chart (SFC) Batch process
Motion control using structured text
State machine operations
Complex mathematical operations
Structured text Specialized array or table loop processing
ASCII string handling or protocol processing

For information about programming in these languages, see the Logix 5000 Controllers
Common Procedures Programming Manual,
publication 1756-PM001.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 221


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Add-On Instructions You can design and configure sets of commonly used instructions to increase project
consistency. Similar to the built-in instructions contained in Logix 5000 controllers, these
instructions you create are called Add-On Instructions. Add-On Instructions reuse common
control algorithms. With them, you can do the following:
• Ease maintenance by animating logic for one instance.
• Protect intellectual property with Source Protection.
• Reduce documentation development time.
You can use Add-On Instructions across multiple projects. You can define your instructions,
obtain them from somebody else, or copy them from another project.

This table explains some of the capabilities and advantages of use Add-On Instructions.
Add-On Instruction Capabilities
Capability Description
With Add-On Instructions, you can combine your most commonly used logic into sets of reusable instructions. You save time
Save Time when you create instructions for your projects and share them with others. Add-On Instructions increase project consistency
because commonly used algorithms all work in the same manner, regardless of who implements the project.
You create Add-On Instructions by using one of three editors:
• Relay Ladder
Use Standard Editors • Function Block Diagram
• Structured Text
Once you have created instructions, you can use them in any editor.
You can export Add-On Instructions to other projects and copy and paste them from one project to another. Give each instruction
Export Add-On Instructions a unique name so that you don’t accidentally overwrite another instruction of the same name.
Context views let you visualize the logic of an instruction for an instant, which simplifies online troubleshooting of your Add-On
Use Context Views Instructions. Each instruction contains a revision, a change history, and an auto-generated help page.
When you create an instruction, you enter information for the description fields in dialogs, information that becomes what is
Create Custom Help known as Custom Help. Custom Help makes it easier for you to get the help you need when implementing the instructions.
As the creator of Add-On Instructions, you can limit users of your instructions to read-only access. You can also bar access to the
Apply Source Protection internal logic or local parameters that are used by the instructions. This source protection lets you stop unwanted changes to
your instructions and protects your intellectual property.

Once defined in a project, Add-On Instructions behave similarly to the built-in instructions in
Logix 5000 controllers. They appear on the instruction toolbar for easy access, as do internal
instructions.
Add-On Instructions

Controller Organizer Instruction

222 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Access the Module Object The MODULE object provides status information about a module. To select a particular module
object, set the Object Name operand of the GSV/SSV instruction to the module name. The
specified module must be present in the
I/O Configuration section of the controller organizer and must have a device name.

Create the Add-On Instruction


With Logix Designer application, version 24.00.00 and later, you can access a MODULE object
directly from an Add-On Instruction. Previously, you could access the MODULE object data but
not from within an Add-On Instruction.

You must create a Module Reference parameter when you define the Add-On Instruction to
access the MODULE object data. A Module Reference parameter is an InOut parameter of the
MODULE data type that points to the MODULE Object of a hardware module. You can use
module reference parameters in both Add-On Instruction logic and program logic.

For more information on the Module Reference parameter, see the Logix 5000 Controllers Add-
On Instructions Programming Manual,
publication 1756-PM010, and the Logix Designer application online help.

The MODULE object uses the following attributes to provide status information:
• EntryStatus
• FaultCode
• FaultInfo
• FWSupervisorStatus
• ForceStatus
• Instance
• LEDStatus
• Mode
• Path

The Path attribute is available with Logix Designer application, version 24.00.00 and later. This
attribute provides a communication path to the module.

For more information on the attributes available in the MODULE object, see the Logix 5000
Controllers General Instructions Reference Manual, publication 1756-RM003.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 223


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Monitoring Controller Status The CompactLogix controller uses Get System Value (GSV) and Set System Value (SSV)
instructions to get and set (change) controller data. The controller stores system data in
objects. There’s no status file, as in the PLC-5® processor.

The GSV instruction retrieves the specified information and places it in the destination. The
SSV instruction sets the specified attribute with data from the source. The instructions are
available from the Input/Output tab of the Instruction toolbar.
GSV and SSV Instructions for Monitoring

When you add a GSV/SSV instruction to the program, the object classes, object names, and
attribute names for each instruction are displayed. For the GSV instruction, you can get values
for the available attributes. For the SSV instruction, only those attributes you’re allowed to set
are displayed.

Some object types appear repeatedly, so you have to specify the object name. For example,
there can be several tasks in your application. Each task has its own Task object that you
access by the task name.

There are several objects and attributes that you can use the GSV and SSV instructions to
monitor and set the system. For more information about GSV instructions, SSV instructions,
objects, and attributes see the Logix 5000 Controllers General Instructions Reference Manual,
publication 1756-RM003.

Monitoring I/O Connections If communication with a device in the I/O configuration of the controller does not occur in an
application-specific period, the communication times out and the controller
produces warnings.

The minimum timeout period that, once expired without communication, causes a timeout is
100 ms. The timeout period can be greater, depending on the RPI of the application. For
example, if your application uses the default RPI = 20 ms, the timeout period is 160 ms.

When a timeout does occur, the controller produces these warnings:


• An I/O fault status code is indicated on the status display of the CompactLogix 5370
controller.
• The I/O status indicator on the front of the CompactLogix 5370 controller flashes green.
• A ! shows over the I/O configuration folder and over the devices that have timed
out.
• A module fault code is produced, which you can access via the following:
- The Module Properties dialog box
- A GSV instruction

For more information about I/O faults, see the Logix 5000 Controllers Major, Minor, and I/O
Faults Programming Manual, publication 1756-PM014.
224 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023
Chapter 10 Develop Applications

I/O Communication Timeout


This example can be used with the CompactLogix 5370 controllers:
• The GSV instruction gets the status of the I/O status indicator (via the LEDStatus
attribute of the Module object) and stores it in the IO_LED tag.
• IO_LED is a DINT tag that stores the status of the I/O status indicator or status display
on the front of the controller.
• If IO_LED equals 2, then at least one I/O connection has been lost and the Fault_Alert is
set.
GSV Used to Identify I/O Timeout

For more information about attributes available with the Module object, see the Logix 5000
Controllers General Instructions Reference Manual, publication 1756-RM003.

I/O Communication Timeout to a Specific I/O Module


If communication times out with a device (module) in the I/O configuration of the controller,
the controller produces a fault code and fault information for the module. You can use GSV
instructions to get fault code and information via the FaultCode and FaultInfo attributes of the
Module object.

For more information about attributes available with the Module object, see the Logix 5000
Controllers General Instructions Reference Manual, publication 1756-RM003.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 225


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Interrupt the Execution of Logic and Execute the Fault Handler


Depending on your application, you can want an I/O connection error to cause the Controller
Fault Handler to execute. To do so, set the module property that causes a major fault to result
from an I/O connection error. The major fault causes the execution of the Controller Fault
Handler.
First, develop a routine in the Controller Fault Handler that can respond to
I/O connection faults. In the Module Properties dialog box of the I/O module or parent
communication module, select Major Fault On Controller If Connection Fails While in Run Mode.
I/O Connection Fault Causes Major Fault
I/O Module Properties

Parent Communication Module Properties

For more information about programming the Controller Fault Handler, see the Logix 5000
Controllers Major, Minor, and I/O Faults Programming Manual, publication 1756-PM014.

226 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

System Overhead The controller communicates with other devices at a specified rate (scheduled) or when
there’s processing time available to service the communication.
Time Slice
The system overhead time slice specifies the percentage of time a controller devotes to
service communication. If you have a continuous task, the System Overhead Time Slice
entered in the Advanced tab of the Controller Properties dialog box specifies the continuous
task/service communication ratio. However, if there’s no continuous task, the overhead time
slice has no effect.

This table shows the ratio between the continuous task and service communication at various
system overhead time slices.

Ratio between Continuous Task and Service Communication


At this time slice The continuous task runs Service communication occurs for up to
10% 9 ms 1 ms
20% 4 ms 1 ms
25% 3 ms 1 ms
33% 2 ms 1 ms
50% 1 ms 1 ms
66% 1 ms 2 ms
75% 1 ms 3 ms
80% 1 ms 4 ms
90% 1 ms 9 ms

If the system overhead time slice is less than or equal to 50%, the duration stays fixed at 1 ms.
The same applies for 66% and higher, except there are multiple 1 ms intervals. For example, at
66% there are two 1 ms intervals of consecutive time and at 90% there are nine 1 ms intervals
of consecutive time.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 227


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Configure the System Overhead Time Slice


To configure the system overhead time slice, perform this procedure.
1. In the Controller Organizer, right-click the controller and select Properties.
The Controller Properties dialog box appears.
2. Select the Advanced tab.
3. Enter a numeric value in the System Overhead Time Slice box.
4. Use Run Continuous Task (default) or Reserve for System Tasks.
- Select Run Continue Task when there’s no communication or background tasks to
process; the controller immediately returns to the continuous task.
- Select Reserve for System Task to allocate the entire 1 ms of the system overhead
time slice whether the controller has communication or background tasks to
perform before returning back to the continuous task. This lets you simulate a
communication load on the controller during design and programming before HMIs,
controller to controller messaging, and so forth, are configured.
5. Select OK.

228 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Sample Controller Projects


The application includes sample projects that you can copy and modify to fit your application.
To access the sample projects, complete these steps.
1. From the File menu, select Open.

2. Browse to the sample projects list and select a sample project.


3. Select Open.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 229


Chapter 10 Develop Applications

Notes:

230 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 11

Develop Integrated Motion Over an EtherNet/IP


Network Application

Some of the CompactLogix™ 5370 controllers support Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP™
network. This motion solution is on standard, unmodified EtherNet/IP networks with simple
design or configuration as compared to traditional motion applications.

IMPORTANT The following CompactLogix 5370 controllers support Integrated Motion


over an EtherNet/IP network:
• 1769-L18ERM-BB1B controller
• 1769-L18ERM-BB1BK controller
• 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controller
• 1769-L30ERM controller
• 1769-L30ERMK controller
• 1769-L33ERM controller
• 1769-L33ERMK controller
• 1769-L33ERMO controller
• 1769-L36ERM controller
• 1769-L36ERMO controller
• 1769-L37ERM controller
• 1769-L37ERMK controller
• 1769-L37ERMO controller(1)
• 1769-L38ERM controller
• 1769-L38ERMK controller
• 1769-L38ERMO controller(1)
(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

Integrated Motion on EtherNet/IP applications use the following:


• Standard EtherNet/IP network
• High-performance drives, including the following:
- Kinetix® 350 drives
- Kinetix 5500 drives
- Kinetix 5700 drives
- Kinetix 6500 drives
- PowerFlex® 755 drives
• Standard infrastructure components
• Programming software

For a complete description of how to use a CompactLogix 5370 controller in an application


that uses Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP network, see the Integrated Motion on the
EtherNet/IP Network: Configuration and Startup User Manual, publication MOTION-UM003.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 231


Chapter 11 Develop Integrated Motion Over an EtherNet/IP Network Application

Motion Axes Support The 1769-L18ERM-BB1B, 1769-L18ERM-BB1BK, 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B, 1769-L30ERM, 1769-


L30ERMK, 1769-L33ERM, 1769-L33ERMK, 1769-L33ERMO, 1769-L36ERM, 1769-L36ERMO, 1769-
L37ERM, 1769-L37ERMK, 1769-L37ERMO(1), 1769-L38ERM, 1769-L38ERMK, and 1769-L38ERMO(1)
controllers support the axes that are detailed in this section.

AXIS_VIRTUAL Axis
The AXIS_VIRTUAL axis is an internal axis representation that is not associated with any
physical drives. That is, you can configure the axis but it does not cause any physical motion in
your system.

AXIS_CIP_DRIVE Axis
The AXIS_CIP_DRIVE axis is a motion axis that is used with physical drives to cause physical
motion in your system as determined by your application.

Configuration Types

When adding an axis to your project, you must associate the axis to a drive. Among other
configuration parameters, you must select a configuration type. The axis configuration type is
also considered the drive configuration type.
For example, an AXIS_CIP_DRIVE axis can use a Position Loop configuration and be associated
with a Kinetix 350 drive. The axis is considered a Position Loop-configured axis and the
associated drive is considered a Position Loop-configured drive.

The following drives support these configuration types:


• Kinetix 350, Kinetix 5500, Kinetix 5700, and Kinetix 6500 drives
- Position loop
- Velocity loop
- Torque loop
• PowerFlex 755 drive
- Position loop
- Velocity loop
- Torque loop
- Frequency control

(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

232 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 11 Develop Integrated Motion Over an EtherNet/IP Network Application

Maximum Number of The CompactLogix 5370 controllers support a maximum number of


EtherNet/IP nodes in a project. Any device added to the local Ethernet node in the I/O
Position Loop-configured configuration is counted toward the node limitation of the controller. For more information,
Drives see Chapter 6, page 102.
Drives are counted among the number of nodes in the I/O Configuration section of the Studio
5000® environment. If you use the maximum number of drives that a 1769-L18ERM-BB1B, 1769-
L18ERM-BB1BK, 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B, 1769-L30ERM, 1769-L30ERMK, 1769-L33ERM,
1769-L33ERMK, 1769-L33ERMO, 1769-L36ERM, 1769-L36ERMO, 1769-L37ERM, 1769-L37ERMK, 1769-
L37ERMO(1), 1769-L38ERM, 1769-L38ERMK, or 1769-L38ERMO(1) controller supports in one system,
you can’t add other EtherNet/IP devices to that project.

Position Loop-configured Drive Limits


Among the maximum number drives supported by the controllers, there’s a maximum number
of Position Loop-configured drives that are supported in the project for the controller.

For example, the 1769-L30ERM controller supports a maximum of four Position Loop-
configured drives.

This table lists motion-related specification information for the controllers that support
Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP network.
CompactLogix 5370 Controllers Supporting Integrated Motion on the EtherNet/IP Network
Number of Position Loop-
Number of Drives
Controller Type Drive Types Supported configured Drives
Supported, Max Supported, Max
1769-L18ERM-BB1B 8 2
1769-L18ERM-BB1BK
1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B
1769-L30ERM 16 4
1769-L30ERMK
1769-L33ERM
1769-L33ERMK Kinetix 350 32 8
1769-L33ERMO Kinetix 5500
Kinetix 5700
1769-L36ERM Kinetix 6500
1769-L36ERMO PowerFlex 755
1769-L37ERM 48 16
1769-L37ERMK
1769-L37ERMO(1)
1769-L38ERM
1769-L38ERMK 80 16
1769-L38ERMO(1)
(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

If your solution requires more than 16 Position Loop-configured drives, consider using the
ControlLogix® platform. The ControlLogix platform enables up to 100 Position Loop-configured
drives.

(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 233


Chapter 11 Develop Integrated Motion Over an EtherNet/IP Network Application

Time Synchronization Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP network requires Time Synchronization, also known as
CIP Sync™. CIP Sync provides accurate real-time (real-world time) or Coordinated Universal
Time (UTC) synchronization of CompactLogix 5370 controllers and devices that are connected
over an EtherNet/IP network.
CIP Sync is a time-synchronization protocol that can be applied to various applications. This
chapter focuses on how to use the protocol in applications with Integrated Motion over an
EtherNet/IP network.

In a CompactLogix system, the following devices are CIP Sync-capable:


• All CompactLogix 5370 controllers - Required

IMPORTANT While all CompactLogix 5370 controllers are CIP Sync-capable,


not all controllers support Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP
network.
A controller must be CIP Sync-capable and synchronized with
other devices on the EtherNet/IP network to support Integrated
Motion over an EtherNet/IP network. However, the condition of
being CIP Sync-capable does not exclusively qualify a
CompactLogix 5370 controller to support Integrated Motion over
an EtherNet/IP network.

All controllers and communication modules must have time synchronization enabled to
participate in CIP Sync.

CIP Sync requires that devices in the system function in the following roles:
• Grandmaster, also known as the coordinated system time (CST) master - Sets time for
the entire system and passes the time to a Master
• Master - Sets time for its backplane
• Slave - Uses time set by Master

234 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 11 Develop Integrated Motion Over an EtherNet/IP Network Application

Configure Integrated Motion To use Integrated Motion on the EtherNet/IP network, complete the steps that are detailed in
this section.

IMPORTANT These steps show a 1769-L36ERM controller. The same steps apply to
other CompactLogix 5370 controllers that support Integrated Motion
over an EtherNet/IP network with slight variations in screens.

IMPORTANT This section assumes that you’ve previously created a project for your
1769-L36ERM controller. If you haven’t, do so before continuing.

Enable Time Synchronization


Integrated Motion on the EtherNet/IP network configuration begins with enabling time
synchronization in a CompactLogix 5370 controller.

To enable Time Synchronization on a CompactLogix 5370 controller, complete these steps.


1. In the Controller Organizer, right-click your controller and select Properties.

The Controller Properties dialog box appears.


2. Select the Date/Time tab.
3. Select Enable Time Synchronization.
4. Select OK.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 235


Chapter 11 Develop Integrated Motion Over an EtherNet/IP Network Application

Add a Drive
You can only use these drives in an application that uses Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/
IP network:
• Kinetix 350 drive
• Kinetix 5500 drive
• Kinetix 5700 drive
• Kinetix 6500 drive
• PowerFlex 755 AC drive

IMPORTANT These steps show a Kinetix 350 drive in a 1769-L36ERM control system.
The same steps apply to other CompactLogix 5370 controllers that
support Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP network with slight
variations in screens.
1. In the I/O configuration tree, right-click the Ethernet network and select New Module.

The Select Module Type dialog box appears.


2. Select the desired drive and select Create.

The New Module dialog box appears.

236 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 11 Develop Integrated Motion Over an EtherNet/IP Network Application

3. Enter a name for the module.


4. Enter a description, if desired.
5. Assign an EtherNet/IP address.
For information on setting the IP addresses, see the publications for each drive type
that is listed on page 11.

6. If you must change the configuration for any of the following parameters, select Change
in the Module Definition area:
• Revision
• Electronic Keying
• Connection
• Power Structure
• Verify Power Rating on Connection
The Module dialog box appears.

7. Make the desired changes and select OK.


8. To create the drive in your project, select OK.
9. Add other components that your project requires.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 237


Chapter 11 Develop Integrated Motion Over an EtherNet/IP Network Application

Scalability in Applications CompactLogix 5370 controllers offer various levels of flexibility and scalability to operate in
control systems that use Integrated Motion on EtherNet/IP networks.
Using Integrated Motion
You can use the following controllers in control systems that require simpler configuration and
complex configuration of Integrated Motion on
EtherNet/IP networks parameters:
• 1769-L30ERM, 1769-L30ERMK
• 1769-L33ERM, 1769-L33ERMK
• 1769-L33ERMO
• 1769-L36ERM
• 1769-L36ERMO
• 1769-L37ERM, 1769-L37ERMK
• 1769-L37ERMO(1)
• 1769-L38ERM, 1769-L38ERMK
• 1769-L38ERMO(1)

Control Systems Requiring Simple Configuration

Relatively simple control systems that use Integrated Motion over an


EtherNet/IP network often include unmanaged switches, such as a
Stratix® 2000 switch, and Kinetix 350 drives, as shown in this example.

1769-L33ERM

Stratix 2000

PowerFlex 755
PanelView™ Plus

Kinetix 350

(1) Available at software version 31 and firmware revision 31.

238 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 11 Develop Integrated Motion Over an EtherNet/IP Network Application

Control Systems Requiring Complex Configuration

Complex control systems that use Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP network often
include managed switches. This example shows such a configuration with Stratix 6000 switch,
and Kinetix 6500 and PowerFlex 755 drives.

1769-L33ERM

PanelView Plus Stratix 6000

Kinetix 350

Kinetix 6500

POINT I/O™
PowerFlex 755

1769-L18ERM-BB1B
The 1769-L18ERM-BB1B controller is typically used in control systems that require simpler
configuration regarding using Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP network.

The simpler control system often includes unmanaged switches, such a


Stratix 2000 switch, and Kinetix 350 drives, as shown in this example.

1769-L18ERM-BB1B

Stratix 2000

PowerFlex 755
PanelView Plus

Kinetix 350

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 239


Chapter 11 Develop Integrated Motion Over an EtherNet/IP Network Application

1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B Controller
The 1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B controller is typically used in control systems that require simpler
configuration regarding using Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP network.

The simpler control system often includes unmanaged switches, such a


Stratix 2000 switch, and Kinetix 350 drives, as shown in this example.

1769-L27ERM-QBFC1B

Stratix 2000

PowerFlex 755
PanelView Plus

Kinetix 350

For more information on Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP network, see the publications
that are listed on page 11.

240 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 12

Use a Secure Digital Card

This chapter describes the primary tasks that are required to store a project on an SD card or
load a project from an SD card to the CompactLogix™ 5370 controller.

IMPORTANT The life expectancy of nonvolatile media is dependent on the number of


write cycles that are performed. Nonvolatile media use a wear leveling
technique, or technology for prolonging the service life, but avoid
frequent writes.
Avoid frequent writes when logging data. We recommend that you log
data to a buffer in the memory of your controller and limit the number
of times data is written to removable media.

CompactLogix 5370 controllers support nonvolatile storage through the following SD cards:
• 1784-SD1 - Ships with CompactLogix 5370 controller and offers 1 GB of memory. You can
order more 1784-SD1 cards if desired.
• 1784-SD2 cards - Available for separate purchase and offer 2 GB of memory.

For information on how to install or remove an SD card from a CompactLogix 5370 controller,
see Chapter 4, page 61
.

IMPORTANT We recommend that you leave the SD card installed in the controller and
the card unlocked. The SD card saves extended diagnostic information
that you can send to Rockwell Automation that provides enhanced
diagnostics of your application and firmware revision if circumstances
require this data.
This section briefly describes how to use the SD card when installed in a
CompactLogix 5370 controller. The section details how to store a
project from the controller to the SD card and how to load a project
from the SD card to the controller.
However, you can complete other tasks by using the SD card, such as
the following:
• Change the image that is loaded from the card
• Check for a load that was completed
• Clear an image from the memory card
• Store an empty image
• Change load parameters
• Read/write application data to the card
For more detailed information on how to use an SD card, see the
Logix 5000™ Controllers Nonvolatile Memory Card Programming Manual,
publication 1756-PM017.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 241


Chapter 12 Use a Secure Digital Card

Store or Load a Project with There are several options for when to load the project back into the user memory (RAM) of the
CompactLogix 5370 controller. The controller configuration determines the option that is used.
the Secure Digital Card
This table describes the conditions and necessary configuration settings that are required for
a project to be loaded from an SD card.
Conditions and Settings for Project Loading
Condition to Load
Project from an SD Card Required Setting in
Controller Configuration Notes
into Controller RAM
• During a power cycle, you lose any online changes and
tag values you haven’t stored on the memory card.
• A load from a memory card can also change the firmware
of the controller.
Controller power-up On Power Up
• For more information, see the Logix 5000 Controllers
Nonvolatile Memory Card Programming Manual,
publication 1756-PM017.
• You can use the application to load the project.
• During a power cycle, you lose any online changes and
tag values you haven’t stored on the memory card.
• A load from a memory card can also change the firmware
No project in the of the controller.
controller and you power On Corrupt Memory
up the controller • For more information, see the Logix 5000 Controllers
Nonvolatile Memory Card Programming Manual,
publication 1756-PM017.
• You can use the application to load the project.
You lose any online changes and tag values that you haven’t
Only through application User Initiated stored on the memory card.

242 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 12 Use a Secure Digital Card

Store a Project Follow these steps to store a project. These steps show a 1769-L18ERM-BB1B controller. The
same steps apply for other CompactLogix 5370 controllers.
1. Go online with the controller.
2. Put the controller in Program mode, that is, Remote Program or Program.
3. On the Online toolbar, select the controller properties icon.

4. Select the Nonvolatile Memory tab.


5. Select Load/Store.

If Load/Store is dimmed (unavailable), verify the following:


• You’ve specified the correct communication path and are online with the
controller.
• The memory card is installed.
If the memory card isn’t installed, this message appears in the lower-left corner of
the Nonvolatile Memory tab, indicating the missing card.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 243


Chapter 12 Use a Secure Digital Card

6. Select under what conditions to load the project into the user memory of the controller.
Project that is on the memory card of the Project that is in the user memory of the
controller (if any project is there). controller.

If you select On Power Up or On Corrupt Memory, you must also select the mode that you
want the controller to go to after the load:
• Remote Program
• Remote Run
7. In the Automatic Firmware Update box, use the default (disable) or select the Firmware
Supervisor option.

IMPORTANT The Firmware Supervisor option isn’t used to update the


controller firmware.
8. Select <- Store.

IMPORTANT Store isn’t active if an SD card is locked.


A dialog box displays to confirm the store.
9. To store the project, select Yes.
10. Select OK.
After you select Store, the project is saved to the SD card as indicated by the controller status
indicators. These conditions can exist:
• While the store is in progress, the following occurs:
- The OK indicator is flashing green.
- The SD indicator is flashing green.
- A dialog box indicates that the store is in progress.
• When the store is complete, the following occurs:
- The controller resets itself.
When the controller is resets itself, the status indicators execute a sequence of state
changes, such as the OK status indicator briefly in the steady red state. Wait for the
controller to complete the sequence.
- After the controller fully resets itself, the OK indicator is steady green.
- The SD indicator is off.

IMPORTANT Allow the store to complete without interruption. If you interrupt


the store, data corruption or loss can occur.

244 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Chapter 12 Use a Secure Digital Card

Load a Project Follow these steps to use the application to load the project from an SD card. These steps
show a 1769-L18ERM-BB1B controller. The same steps apply for other CompactLogix 5370
controllers.
1. Go online with the controller.
2. Put the controller in Program mode, that is, Remote Program or Program.
3. On the Online toolbar, select the controller properties icon.

4. Select the Nonvolatile Memory tab.


5. Select Load/Store.

6. Select Load.
Project that is on the memory card of the controller Project that is in the user memory of
(if any project is there). the controller.

A dialog box prompts you to confirm the load.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 245


Chapter 12 Use a Secure Digital Card

7. To load the project, select Yes.


8. Select OK.

After you select Load, the project is loaded into the controller as indicated by the controller
status indicators. These conditions can exist:
• While the load is in progress, the following occurs:
- The controller resets itself.
When the controller is resetting itself, the status indicators execute a sequence of
state changes, for example, a brief time with the OK status indicator in the steady
red state. Wait for the controller to complete the sequence.
- After the controller fully resets itself, the OK indicator is steady green.
The SD indicator is off.

246 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Appendix A

Troubleshoot the Module

This section explains how to interpret the status indicators on your CompactLogix™ 5370
controllers. All controllers use the status indicators that are described in this table.
Status Indicator Description
RUN Indicates the operating mode of the controller.
FORCE Indicates the force state.
I/O Indicates the current state of communication between the controller and I/O modules.
OK Indicates the state of the controller.
NS Indicates the EtherNet/IP™ network status regarding the controller operating on the network.
LINK 1 Indicates the EtherNet/IP link status for port 1 if the controller.
LINK 2 Indicates the EtherNet/IP link status for port 2 of the controller.
SD Indicates if there’s activity on the SD card.

Use Logix Designer This section details the ways in which the Logix Designer application indicates fault
conditions.
Application for
Troubleshooting Warning signal on the main screen next to the module - This occurs when the connection to
the module is broken. The controller state also indicates Faulted and the Controller fault is
illuminated in red.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 247


Appendix A Troubleshoot the Module

Message in the status line of a screen.

On the Module Info tab, in the Status section, the Major and Minor Faults are listed along with
the Internal State of the module.

Notification in the Tag Editor - General module faults are also reported in the Tag Editor.
Diagnostic faults are reported only in the tag editor.

The Value field indicates a fault with the number 1.

248 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Appendix A Troubleshoot the Module

Fault Type Determination


To display recent fault information in the Major Faults tab of the Module Properties screen, you
must select the Major Fault on Controller option in the Connection tab.

The Major Faults tab indicates the type of fault under Recent Faults. A fault displays here when
you’re monitoring the configuration properties of a module in the Logix Designer application
and receive a Communication fault message.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 249


Appendix A Troubleshoot the Module

Use the CompactLogix 5370 This graphic shows the controller status indicators for all CompactLogix 5370 controllers.
Controllers Status
Indicators

Controller Mode (RUN) Status Indicator


Status Description
Off The controller is in Program or Test mode.
Green The controller is in Run mode.

Force State (FORCE) Status Indicator


Status Description
Off No tags contain I/O force values. I/O forces are inactive (disabled).
Yellow I/O forces are active (enabled). I/O force values can exist.
One or more input or output addresses have been forced to an On or Off condition, but
Flashing yellow the forces haven’t been enabled.

I/O State (I/O) Status Indicator


Status Description
One of the following conditions exists:
• There are no devices in the I/O configuration of the controller. - Applies to only
Off CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers.
• The controller does not contain a project.
Green The controller is communicating with all devices in its I/O configuration.
Flashing green One or more devices in the I/O configuration of the controller aren’t responding.
One of the following conditions exists:
• The controller isn’t communicating with any devices.
Flashing red
• A fault has occurred on the controller. - Only CompactLogix 5370 L1 and L2
controllers.

Controller Status (OK) Status Indicator


Status Description
Off No power is applied.
Green The controller is OK.
Flashing green The controller is storing a project to or loading a project from the SD card.
The controller detected a nonrecoverable major fault and cleared the project
Red from memory.
One of the following:
• The controller requires a firmware update.
• A major recoverable fault occurred on the controller.
Flashing red • A nonrecoverable major fault occurred on the controller and cleared the program
from memory.
• A controller firmware update is in process.
• An embedded I/O module firmware update is in process. - Only CompactLogix 5370
L1 controllers.
Dim green to red Save to Flash at power-down.

250 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Appendix A Troubleshoot the Module

Ethernet Network Status (NS) Status Indicator


Status Description
The port isn’t initialized; it does not have an IP address and is operating in BOOTP or
Off DHCP mode.
Green The port has an IP address and CIP™ connections are established.
Flashing green The port has an IP address, but no CIP connections are established.
Red The port has detected that the assigned IP address is in use.
Flashing red/green The port is performing its power-up self-test.

Ethernet Link Status (LINK 1/LINK 2) Status Indicator


Status Description
One of the following conditions exists:
• No link.
Off
• Port administratively disabled.
• Port disabled because rapid ring fault condition was detected (LINK2).
One of the following conditions exists:
• A 100 Mbps link (half- or full-duplex) exists, no activity.
• A 10 Mbps link (half- or full-duplex) exists, no activity.
Green
• Ring network is operating normally and the controller is the active supervisor.
• Ring network has encountered a rare partial network fault and the controller is the
active supervisor.
One of the following conditions exists:
Flashing green • A 100 Mbps link exists and there’s activity.
• A 10 Mbps link exists and there’s activity.

SD Card Activity (SD) Status Indicator


Status Description
Off There’s no activity to the SD card.
Flashing green The controller is reading from or writing to the SD card.
Flashing red The SD card does not have a file system.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 251


Appendix A Troubleshoot the Module

Notes:

252 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Appendix B

Replacement Considerations

CompactLogix™ 5370 L1 series B and C controllers are direct replacements of the series A
controllers. The series B and C controllers have an improved power supply circuit to the
isolated power supply so that a second power supply is no longer needed.

The series A controller requires two power supplies:


• One to supply the controller power (VDC)
• One to supply the field power (FP)

Product Comparison This section details certain characteristics to consider when comparing CompactLogix 5370 L1
series A, B, and C controllers.

Power Considerations
CompactLogix 5370 L1 series A, B, and C controllers
Characteristics CompactLogix L1 Series B and C CompactLogix L1 Series A
Power dissipation 11.5 W 12 W
Recommended external short circuit User-provided 4...6 A @
User-provided 4...5 A @ 3.15...5.5 I²t fuse
protection, field power 52.5...68.25 I²t fuse
Embedded power supply 24V DC input, isolated 24V DC input, non-isolated
Line requirement (V DC), min 30VA 50VA
Current draw @ 24V DC, field power, max 3 A @ 24V DC –

Embedded DC Input Considerations


CompactLogix 5370 L1 series A, B, and C controllers
Characteristics CompactLogix L1 Series B and C CompactLogix L1 Series A
Off-state current, max 1 mA 1.5 mA
Input impedance, max 5.4 k 4.7 k

Firmware Compatibility
For the latest information regarding firmware compatibility, refer to Rockwell Automation
Product Compatibility and Download Center at: rok.auto/pcdc

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 253


Appendix B Replacement Considerations

Dimensions There are no dimension differences between the series A controller and the series B and C
controllers.
12.00 mm
(0.47 in.)

100.00 mm
(3.94 in.)
105 mm
(4.13 in.)

130.00 mm
(5.11 in.)

144.00 mm
(5.67 in.)

254 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Appendix B Replacement Considerations

Power Supply Wiring Series B and C Wiring

Series A Wiring

Fuse
IMPORTANT: No wires are
connected to the NC terminal.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 255


Appendix B Replacement Considerations

Examples

Replace the Controller

In this example:
• Replace a series A controller with a series B or C controller
OR
• Replace a series B controller with a series C controller

Requirements:
Category Tasks
The series B or C controller requires only one power supply,
but the series B or C controller does support two power
Power Supply Wiring supplies. You can retain the current power supply design for
the series A controller and avoid rewiring.
Refer to Rockwell Automation Product Compatibility and
Controller Firmware Download Center (PCDC) at: rok.auto/pcdc.
Install the Studio 5000 environment compatible with the
Programming Software controller firmware obtained from the PCDC.
Use an operating system compatible with the Studio 5000
Personal Computer environment obtained from the PCDC.

256 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Appendix C

Connect Power to the Series A


CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

This appendix explains how to connect power to series A L1 CompactLogix™ 5370 controllers.

Connect External Power to


Series A L1 Controllers IMPORTANT This section describes how to power the controller via the VDC+ and
VDC- terminals.
Connections to the VDC+ and VDC- terminals do not provide power to
input or output devices that are connected to the embedded I/O
modules of the controller or local expansion modules. You must connect
power to the FP+ and FP- terminals to provide power to I/O devices that
are connected to the embedded I/O modules of the controller or local
expansion modules.
For more information on how to provide power to input or output
devices that are connected to the embedded I/O modules of the
controller and local expansion modules, see page 261.

The external power supply must be dedicated to the embedded supply of the controller. The
external power supply converts 115/230V AC power to 24V DC or other application-required DC
voltage that is within the operating range of the controller.

WARNING: Do not connect directly to line voltage. Line voltage must be supplied
by a suitable, approved isolating transformer or power supply having short
circuit capacity not exceeding 100VA maximum or equivalent. The controller
power requirement is 50VA.

Power is connected to the controller via a removable connector that is connected to the front
of the controller. The following graphic shows the connector.

IMPORTANT The controller is grounded once it’s installed on a DIN rail as


described on page 28.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 257


Appendix C Connect Power to the Series A CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Consider these points before completing the steps in this section:


• This section describes how to connect an external 24V DC power source to the
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller.
For information on how to provide field power to input and output devices that are
connected to the embedded I/O modules of the controller and local expansion modules
via the removable connector, see page 117.

ATTENTION: You must use an external power supply that is Class 2 or


SELV-listed.

• The external power supply that provides power to the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller
must be dedicated to power the controller.
• You must use a separate, dedicated external 24V DC power source to connect power to
other terminals on the removable connector and devices in the system, for example, the
FP+ terminal or a barcode scanner, respectively.
• The external 24V DC power source that is connected to the VDC+ and VDC- terminals on
the removable connector must reside in the same enclosure as the CompactLogix 5370
L1 controller.
• Use a power source that most effectively meets your application needs. That is,
calculate the power requirements for your application before choosing a power source
to avoid using a power source that far exceeds your application requirements.
• This section assumes that any DIN rail that you use has been grounded following
Industrial Automation Wiring and Grounding Guidelines, publication 1770-4.1.
• The embedded power supply of the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller provides power to
the controller and POINTBus™ backplane. It does not provide field-side power to the
embedded I/O or local expansion modules.
• Not all Class 2/SELV-listed power supplies are certified for use in all applications, for
example, use in nonhazardous and hazardous environments.
Before installing an external power supply, consult all specification and certification
information to verify that you’re using an acceptable external power supply.
• For example purposes, this section describes how to use a 1606-XLE120E, NEC Class 2
switched-mode power supply. The exact steps for other external power supplies can
vary from the steps that are described here.

258 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Appendix C Connect Power to the Series A CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Complete these steps to connect power to the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller. CompactLogix
5370 L1 Series B and C controllers can also be connected to power as instructed in this
procedure.
1. Verify that the external 24V DC power source isn’t powered.
2. Mount the external 24V DC power source on a DIN rail.
The external 24V DC power source can be installed on the same DIN rail as the controller
or a separate DIN rail.
3. Connect the wires to the 24V DC+ and 24V DC- connections on the external 24V DC
power source.

WARNING: If you connect or disconnect the wiring while the field-side power is
on, an electric arc can occur. This could cause an explosion in hazardous
location installations. Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous
before proceeding.

4. Pull the removable connector off the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller.

5. Connect the wire that is connected to the 24V DC+ terminal on the external 24V DC
power source to the VDC+ terminal. The VDC+ terminal is the top terminal on the
removable connector.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 259


Appendix C Connect Power to the Series A CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

6. Connect the wire that is connected to the 24V DC- terminal on the external 24V DC
power source to the VDC- terminal. The VDC- terminal is second from the top on the
removable connector.

IMPORTANT If your application requires a power control device, for example, a


switch or relay, between the external 24V DC power source and the
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller to control when the controller is
powered, you must install the power control device at the VDC+ terminal
on the removable connector.
If you install the power control device at the VDC- terminal, the
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller can have problems powering up or
powering down properly.

7. Plug the removable connector back into the controller.


8. Secure the removable connector in place.

9. Turn on power to the external 24V DC power source.


The following graphic shows an external 24V DC power source that is connected to a
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller.

260 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Appendix C Connect Power to the Series A CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Connect Field Power to Complete these steps to connect field power to the CompactLogix 5370 L1 series A controller.
CompactLogix 5370 L1 Series B and C controllers can also be connected to field power as
Series A L1 Controllers for I/ instructed in this procedure.
O Devices 1. Verify that the separate external 24V DC power source that powers the CompactLogix
5370 L1 controller isn’t powered.
2. Verify that the external 24V DC power source that is connected to the FP+ and FP-
terminals isn’t powered.
3. Mount the external power supply that connects to the FP+ and FP- terminals on a DIN
rail.
The external power supply can be installed on the same DIN rail as the controller or a
separate DIN rail.
4. Connect wires to the appropriate + and - connections on the external 24V DC power
source.

WARNING: If you connect or disconnect wiring while the field-side power is on,
an electric arc can occur. This could cause an explosion in hazardous location
installations. Be sure that power is removed or the area is nonhazardous before
proceeding.
5. Pull the removable connector off the CompactLogix 5370 L1 controller.
Wires that are connected between external
24V DC power source and VDC+ and VDC-
terminals on the removable connector.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 261


Appendix C Connect Power to the Series A CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

6. Connect the wire that is connected to the + terminal on the external 24V DC power
source to the FP+ terminal. The FP+ terminal is the fourth terminal from the top on the
removable connector.

7. Connect the wire that is connected to the - terminal on the external 24V DC power
source to the FP- terminal. The FP- terminal is the fifth terminal from the top on the
removable connector.

8. Plug the removable connector into the controller.


9. Secure the removable connector in place.

10. Turn on power to the separate external 24V DC power source connected to the VDC+
and VDC- terminals of the removable connector.

262 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Appendix C Connect Power to the Series A CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

11. Turn on power to the external 24V DC power source connected to the FP+ and FP-
terminals of the removable connector.

This graphic shows separate external 24V DC power supplies connected to the VDC+/VDC-
and FP+/FP- terminals on the removable connector, respectively.

VDC Power Supply

IMPORTANT: No wires are


Fuse connected to the NC terminal.

FP Power Supply

IMPORTANT Install a user-replaceable fuse with overcurrent protection of


4…6 A @ 52.5…68.25 I2t in line between the incoming power and the
FP+ terminal.

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 263


Appendix C Connect Power to the Series A CompactLogix 5370 L1 Controllers

Notes:

264 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Index

Numerics wiring diagrams 123


embedded power supply 24, 258
1734 POINT I/O modules 117 - 144 example EtherNet/IP network system
BUS OFF detection and recovery 144 configuration 18
configure 138 - 142 grounding 28, 30
monitor faults 143 I/O modules 117 - 144
removal and insertion under power 131 installation 21 - 37
requested packet interval 132 grounding 30
select 117 minimum spacing 28
using as local expansion modules with mounting 28 - 29
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers SD card 26 - 27
24 system dimensions 29
validate layout 131 - 134 integrated motion over an EtherNet/IP
1769 Compact I/O modules 189 - 209 network 231 - 240
calculate system power consumption 194 - local expansion modules 24
196 BUS OFF detection and recovery 144
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 59 removal and insertion under power 131
configure 179 - 181, 201 - 207 minimum spacing 28
connections 181, 202 mounting 28 - 29
end cap detection 188, 209 networks
local banks available with CompactLogix EtherNet/IP network connection 37
5370 L3 controllers 59 USB connection 36
monitor faults 187, 208 parts 25
requested packet interval 175, 181, 193, 202 place I/O modules 134
select 145, 189 rack-optimized connections 139
using as local expansion modules with select I/O modules 117
CompactLogix 5370 L2 selecting operating mode 97 - 98
controllers 41 status indicators 247 - 251
validate layout 193 - 199 system components 14, 23
1769 Compact I/O power supplies system dimensions 29
calculate system power consumption 194 - wiring diagrams 123
196 CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers
1784-SD1 and 1784-SD2 cards 25, 42 connecting power 52 - 54
installation connections to I/O modules 181
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 26 - DIN rail use 45
27 direct connections 181
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 43 - embedded I/O module 41
44 embedded power supply 41, 52
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 61 - example DeviceNet network system
62 configuration 20
example EtherNet/IP network system
configuration 19
A grounding 45, 49
installation 39 - 56
Add-On Instructions grounding 49
in project 222 minimum spacing 45
application mounting 45 - 46
elements 211 SD card 43 - 44
AutoFlash 90 system dimensions 46
load firmware 94 - 96 integrated motion over an EtherNet/IP
network 231 - 240
local expansion modules 41
B minimum spacing 45
mounting 45 - 46
BOOTP server 73 networks
set IP address 75 - 78 EtherNet/IP network connection 56
USB connection 55
parts 42
C rack-optimized connections 181
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers select I/O modules 145
selecting operating mode 97 - 98
connecting power 32 - 35, 257 - 263
connections to I/O modules 139 status indicators 247 - 251
system components 14, 41
DIN rail use 28 system dimensions 46
direct connections 139
embedded I/O module 24

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 265


Index

CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers D


available local I/O banks 59 develop
calculate system power consumption 194 -
196 applications 211
connecting power 64 Device Level Ring topology 72
connections to I/O modules 202 DHCP server 73
DIN rail use 70 set IP address 80
direct connections 202 DIN rail
example DeviceNet network system CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 28
configuration 20 CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 45
example EtherNet/IP network system CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 70
configuration 19 direct connections
grounding 69
I/O modules 189 - 209 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 139
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 181
installation 57 - 72
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 202
grounding 69
distance rating
minimum spacing 66
mounting 70 power supply
SD card 61 - 62 CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 59,
system dimensions 68 69
integrated motion over an EtherNet/IP
network 231 - 240
local 1769 Compact I/O modules 59 E
minimum spacing 66 elements
mounting 66 - 69, 70 control application 211
networks embedded I/O module
EtherNet/IP network connection 72
USB connection 71 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 24
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 41
parts 60
wiring diagrams 123
power supply
distance rating 59, 69 embedded power supply
rack-optimized connections 202 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 258
select I/O modules 189 calculate system power consumption
selecting operating mode 97 - 98 134, 176
status indicators 247 - 251 CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 52
system components 14, 59 enclosures
system dimensions 68 minimum spacing
configure CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 28
I/O modules CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 45
for use with CompactLogix 5370 L1 system dimensions
controllers 138 - 142 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 29
for use with CompactLogix 5370 L2 CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 46
controllers 179 - 181 EtherNet/IP network
for use with CompactLogix 5370 L3 available network topologies 37, 56, 72
controllers 201 - 207 change IP address 86 - 89
system overhead time slice 228 via Logix Designer application 88
connections via RSLinx Classic software 87
direct via SD card 89
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 139 connection for CompactLogix 5370 L1
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 181 controllers 37
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 202 connection for CompactLogix 5370 L2
rack-optimized controllers 56
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 139 connection for CompactLogix 5370 L3
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 181 controllers 72
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 202 example configurations 18 - 19
to I/O modules Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 139 network 16, 231 - 240
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 181 set IP address 74 - 85
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 202 via BOOTP server 75 - 78
continuous task 214 via DHCP server 80
via Logix Designer application 82 - 84
ControlFLASH utility 73, 90 via RSLinx Classic software 81 - 82
load firmware 90 - 93 via SD card 85
controller event task 135 - 137, 214
monitor
connections 224
program 216 F
routine 218
tags 219 fault code
tasks 212 use GSV to get 225

266 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Index

faults CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 145


monitor I/O module faults CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 189
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 143 validate layout
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 187 1734 POINT I/O modules 131 - 134
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 208 1769 Compact I/O modules 175 - 178,
firmware 193 - 199
load 90 - 96 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 131 -
via AutoFlash 94 - 96 134
via ControlFLASH utility 90 - 93 CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 175
via SD card 96 - 178
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 193
- 199
G installation
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 21 - 37
grounding CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 39 - 56
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 28, 30 CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 57 - 72
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 45, 49 DIN rail
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 69 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 28
GSV CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 45
fault code 225 CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 70
monitor grounding
connection 225 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 30
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 49
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 69
I local 1769 Compact I/O modules
I/O modules CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 189
minimum spacing
calculate system power consumption CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 28
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 134 CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 45
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 176 CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 66
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 194 mounting
- 196 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 28 -
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 117 - 144 29
BUS OFF detection and recovery 144 CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 45 -
local expansion modules 127 46
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 145 - 188 CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 66 -
local expansion modules 172 69, 70
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 189 - 209 panel mounting
local 1769 Compact I/O modules 59 CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 70
configure power supply connections to CompactLogix
for use with CompactLogix 5370 L1 5370 L1 controllers 32 - 35, 257 -
controllers 138 - 142 263
for use with CompactLogix 5370 L2 power supply connections to CompactLogix
controllers 179 - 181 5370 L2 controllers 52 - 54
for use with CompactLogix 5370 L3 required software tasks 73 - 98
controllers 201 - 207 SD card
connections CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 26 -
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 139 27
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 181 CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 43 -
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 202 44
embedded I/O module on CompactLogix CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 61 -
5370 L1 controllers 24 62
embedded I/O module on CompactLogix system dimensions
5370 L2 controllers 41 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 29
end cap detection CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 46
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 188 CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 68
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 209 Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP
monitor faults
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 143 network 16, 231 - 240
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 187 configure 235 - 237
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 208 drive limits 233
place example configuration
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 134 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 239
requested packet interval 181, 202 CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 240
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 132, supported axes 232
139 time synchronization 234
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 175 IP address 73
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 193 change 86 - 89
select via Logix Designer application 88
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 117 via RSLinx Classic software 87

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 267


Index

via SD card 89 5370 L1 controllers 37


set 74 - 85 network connection for CompactLogix
via BOOTP server 75 - 78 5370 L2 controllers 56
via DHCP server 80 network connection for CompactLogix
via Logix Designer application 82 - 84 5370 L3 controllers 72
via RSLinx Classic software 81 - 82 set IP address via BOOTP server 75 - 78
via SD card 85 set IP address via DHCP server 80
set IP address via Logix Designer ap-
plication 82 - 84
L set IP address via RSLinx Classic soft-
linear network topology 72 ware 81 - 82
set IP address via SD card 85
local 1769 Compact I/O modules USB
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 59 connection for CompactLogix 5370 L1
local expansion modules controllers 36
1734 POINT I/O modules 24 connection for CompactLogix 5370 L2
1769 Compact I/O modules 41 controllers 55
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 24 connection for CompactLogix 5370 L3
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 41 controllers 71
local I/O banks
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 59
Logix Designer application O
AutoFlash 90 operating mode
change IP address 88 selecting 97 - 98
configure I/O modules
for use with CompactLogix 5370 L1
controllers 138 - 142 P
for use with CompactLogix 5370 L2
controllers 179 - 181 panel mounting
for use with CompactLogix 5370 L3 CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 70
controllers 201 - 207 periodic task 214
Integrated Motion over an EtherNet/IP power supply
network 231 - 240 connections to CompactLogix 5370 L1
load a project to an SD card 245 - 246 controllers 32 - 35, 257 - 263
set IP address 82 - 84 connections to CompactLogix 5370 L2
store a project to an SD card 243 - 244 controllers 52 - 54
using event task 135 - 137 connections to CompactLogix 5370 L3
controllers 64
distance rating
M CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 69
memory storage embedded power supply with CompactLogix
SD cards 25, 42 5370 L1 controllers 24, 258
minimum spacing embedded power supply with CompactLogix
5370 L2 controllers 41, 52
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 28 priority
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 45
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 66 task 215
mounting program
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 28 - 29 in project 216
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 45 - 46 scheduled 217
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 66 - 69, system overhead time slice 227
70 unscheduled 217
programming languages 221
project
N elements 211
networks
DeviceNet
example CompactLogix 5370 L2 con-
R
troller system configuration 20 rack-optimized connections
example CompactLogix 5370 L3 con- CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 139
troller system configuration 20 CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 181
EtherNet/IP CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 202
change IP address via Logix Designer removal and insertion under power
application 88 local expansion modules
change IP address via RSLinx Classic CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 131
software 87
change IP address via SD card 89
example configurations 18 - 19
network connection for CompactLogix

268 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Index

requested packet interval 1734 POINT I/O modules 131 - 134


CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 132, 139 1769 Compact I/O modules 175 - 178
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 175, 181 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 131 -
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 193, 202 134
routine CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 175
in project 218 - 178
RSLinx Classic software 73 CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 193
- 199
change IP address 87 system components
set IP address 81 - 82
RSLogix 5000 software 73 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 14, 23
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 14, 41
RSNetWorx for DeviceNet software 73 CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 14, 59
system dimensions
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 29
S CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 46
sample projects 229 CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 68
scheduled system overhead time slice 227
program 217 configure 228
SD card 90, 241 - 246 system power consumption
change IP address 89 calculate
installation CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 134,
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 26 - 176
27 CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 194
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 43 - - 196
44
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 61 -
62 T
load a project 245 - 246 tag
load firmware 96 in project 219
set IP address 85 task
store a project 243 - 244
software continuous 214
event 135 - 137, 214
BOOTP 73 in project 212
set IP address 75 - 78 periodic 214
DHCP 73 priority 215
set IP address 80 time slice 227
Logix Designer application
AutoFlash 90
required installation tasks 73 - 98
RSLinx Classic 73 U
change IP address 87 unscheduled
set IP address 81 - 82 program 217
RSLogix 5000 73 USB cable
RSNetWorx for DeviceNet 73 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 36
Studio 5000 environment 73 CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 55
star network topology 72 CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 71
status
monitor
connections 224 V
status indicators 247 - 251 validate I/O modules layout
Studio 5000 environment 73 1734 POINT I/O modules 131 - 134
Studio 5000 Logix Designer application. See 1769 Compact I/O modules 175 - 178, 193 -
Logix Designer application 199
system assembly
calculate system power consumption
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 134, W
176 wiring diagrams
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers 194 CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 123
- 196
CompactLogix 5370 L3 controllers
select I/O modules 189
place I/O modules
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 134
select I/O modules
CompactLogix 5370 L1 controllers 117
CompactLogix 5370 L2 controllers 145
validate I/O modules layout

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 269


Index

270 Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


CompactLogix 5370 Controllers User Manual

Rockwell Automation Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023 271


Rockwell Automation Support
Use these resources to access support information.
Find help with how-to videos, FAQs, chat, user forums, Knowledgebase, and product
Technical Support Center rok.auto/support
notification updates.
Local Technical Support Phone Numbers Locate the telephone number for your country. rok.auto/phonesupport
Quickly access and download technical specifications, installation instructions, and user
Technical Documentation Center rok.auto/techdocs
manuals.
Literature Library Find installation instructions, manuals, brochures, and technical data publications. rok.auto/literature
Product Compatibility and Download Center Download firmware, associated files (such as AOP, EDS, and DTM), and access product rok.auto/pcdc
(PCDC) release notes.

Documentation Feedback
Your comments help us serve your documentation needs better. If you have any suggestions on how to improve our content, complete the
form at rok.auto/docfeedback.

Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment (WEEE)

At the end of life, this equipment should be collected separately from any unsorted municipal waste.

Rockwell Automation maintains current product environmental compliance information on its website at rok.auto/pec.

Allen-Bradley, Armor, ArmorBlock, Compact I/O, ControlFLASH, CompactLogix, ControlLogix, DriveLogix, E3 Electronic Overload Relay, expanding human possibility, FLEX I/O, FlexLogix, Integrated
Architecture Builder, Kinetix, Logix 5000, On-Machine, PanelConnect, PanelView Plus, PLC-5, POINT I/O, POINTBus, PowerFlex, QuickView, Rockwell Automation, RSLinx Classic, RSLogix 5000,
RSNetWorx, SLC, SoftLogix, Stratix, Studio 5000, and Studio 5000 Logix Designer are trademarks of Rockwell Automation, Inc.
CIP, CIP Sync, DeviceNet, and EtherNet/IP are trademarks of ODVA, Inc.
Trademarks not belonging to Rockwell Automation are property of their respective companies.
Rockwell Otomasyon Ticaret A.Ş. Kar Plaza İş Merkezi E Blok Kat:6 34752, İçerenköy, İstanbul, Tel: +90 (216) 5698400 EEE Yönetmeliğine Uygundur

Publication 1769-UM021K-EN-P - May 2023


Supersedes Publication 1769-UM021I-EN-P - May 2018 Copyright © 2023 Rockwell Automation, Inc. All rights reserved. Printed in the U.S.A.

You might also like